1 //===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements the ASTContext interface. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 15 #include "CXXABI.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h" 29 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h" 30 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 31 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 32 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h" 33 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 34 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 35 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 37 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h" 38 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 39 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h" 40 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h" 41 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" 42 #include <map> 43 44 using namespace clang; 45 46 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors; 47 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared; 48 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors; 49 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared; 50 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors; 51 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared; 52 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators; 53 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared; 54 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators; 55 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared; 56 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors; 57 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared; 58 59 enum FloatingRank { 60 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank 61 }; 62 63 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const { 64 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) { 65 ExternalSource->ReadComments(); 66 67 #ifndef NDEBUG 68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments(); 69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(), 70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr))); 71 #endif 72 73 CommentsLoaded = true; 74 } 75 76 assert(D); 77 78 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations. 79 if (D->isImplicit()) 80 return nullptr; 81 82 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations. 83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 85 return nullptr; 86 } 87 88 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 91 return nullptr; 92 } 93 94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { 95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 96 return nullptr; 97 } 98 99 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD = 100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { 101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind(); 102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared) 104 return nullptr; 105 } 106 107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) { 108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 109 return nullptr; 110 } 111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) { 112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the 113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment 114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition()) 115 return nullptr; 116 } 117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly. 118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D)) 119 return nullptr; 120 121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template 122 // documentation. 123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) || 124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) || 125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D)) 126 return nullptr; 127 128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments(); 129 130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything. 131 if (RawComments.empty()) 132 return nullptr; 133 134 // Find declaration location. 135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple 136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration 137 // location". 138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently, 139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location". 140 SourceLocation DeclLoc; 141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) || 142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) || 143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) || 144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) 145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart(); 146 else { 147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation(); 148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) { 149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) { 150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being 151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as 152 // the "declaration location". 153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart(); 154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) { 155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of 156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special 157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that 158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can 159 // attach the comment to the tag decl. 160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) && 161 TD->isCompleteDefinition()) 162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc); 163 } 164 } 165 } 166 167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we 168 // can't find the comment. 169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID()) 170 return nullptr; 171 172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration. 173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment; 174 { 175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking 176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them 177 // first. 178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc( 179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false, 180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments); 181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr); 182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1; 183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc); 184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) { 185 MaybeBeforeDecl--; 186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc); 187 } 188 189 if (Found) { 190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1; 191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(), 192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare)); 193 } else { 194 // Slow path. 195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(), 196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare); 197 } 198 } 199 200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the 201 // file buffer. 202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc); 203 204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment. 205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() && 206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() && 207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) || 208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) { 209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp 210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin()); 211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts 212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration. 213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first && 214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second) 215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first, 216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) { 217 return *Comment; 218 } 219 } 220 221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment. 222 // Let's look at the previous comment. 223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin()) 224 return nullptr; 225 --Comment; 226 227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment. 228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment()) 229 return nullptr; 230 231 // Decompose the end of the comment. 232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp 233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 234 235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they 236 // aren't related. 237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first) 238 return nullptr; 239 240 // Get the corresponding buffer. 241 bool Invalid = false; 242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first, 243 &Invalid).data(); 244 if (Invalid) 245 return nullptr; 246 247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration. 248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second, 249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second); 250 251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between 252 // comment and declaration. 253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos) 254 return nullptr; 255 256 return *Comment; 257 } 258 259 namespace { 260 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to 261 /// refer to the actual template. 262 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template. 263 const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) { 264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template? 266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 267 return FTD; 268 269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation. 270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 271 return D; 272 273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template? 274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate()) 275 return FTD; 276 277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template? 278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl = 279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) 280 return MemberDecl; 281 282 return D; 283 } 284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class 286 // template? 287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember()) 288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) 289 return MemberDecl; 290 291 return D; 292 } 293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { 294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template? 295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 296 return CTD; 297 298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial 299 // specialization? 300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD = 301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) { 302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 303 return D; 304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *, 305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *> 306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial(); 307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ? 308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) : 309 static_cast<const Decl*>( 310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>()); 311 } 312 313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template? 314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info = 315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) 316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom(); 317 318 return D; 319 } 320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) { 321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template? 322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum()) 323 return MemberDecl; 324 325 return D; 326 } 327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates? 328 return D; 329 } 330 } // unnamed namespace 331 332 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl( 333 const Decl *D, 334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const { 335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D); 336 337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already. 338 { 339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos = 340 RedeclComments.find(D); 341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) { 342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second; 343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) { 344 if (OriginalDecl) 345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl(); 346 return Raw.getRaw(); 347 } 348 } 349 } 350 351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain. 352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr; 353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr; 354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos = 356 RedeclComments.find(I); 357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) { 358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second; 359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) { 360 RC = Raw.getRaw(); 361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl(); 362 break; 363 } 364 } else { 365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I); 366 OriginalDeclForRC = I; 367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw; 368 if (RC) { 369 Raw.setRaw(RC); 370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl); 371 } else 372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl); 373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I); 374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw; 375 if (RC) 376 break; 377 } 378 } 379 380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment. 381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation()); 382 383 if (OriginalDecl) 384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC; 385 386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain. 387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw; 388 Raw.setRaw(RC); 389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl); 390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC); 391 392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I]; 394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) 395 R = Raw; 396 } 397 398 return RC; 399 } 400 401 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod, 402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) { 403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext(); 404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) { 405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface(); 406 if (!ID) 407 return; 408 // Add redeclared method here. 409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) { 410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod = 411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(), 412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod())) 413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod); 414 } 415 } 416 } 417 418 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC, 419 const Decl *D) const { 420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo; 421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D; 422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false; 423 ThisDeclInfo->fill(); 424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl(); 425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters) 426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters; 427 comments::FullComment *CFC = 428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(), 429 ThisDeclInfo); 430 return CFC; 431 432 } 433 434 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const { 435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D); 436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr; 437 } 438 439 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl( 440 const Decl *D, 441 const Preprocessor *PP) const { 442 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 443 return nullptr; 444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D); 445 446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl(); 447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos = 448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical); 449 450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) { 451 if (Canonical != D) { 452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second; 453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D); 454 return CFC; 455 } 456 return Pos->second; 457 } 458 459 const Decl *OriginalDecl; 460 461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl); 462 if (!RC) { 463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden; 465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D); 466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor()) 467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl()) 468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP)) 469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 470 if (OMD) 471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden); 472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden); 473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++) 474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP)) 475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 476 } 477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter 479 // does not have one of its own. 480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType(); 481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>()) 482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl()) 483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP)) 484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 485 } 486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) { 488 IC = IC->getSuperClass(); 489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP)) 490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 491 } 492 } 493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) { 494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface()) 495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP)) 496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 497 } 498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { 499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition())) 500 return nullptr; 501 // Check non-virtual bases. 502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) { 503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)) 504 continue; 505 QualType Ty = I.getType(); 506 if (Ty.isNull()) 507 continue; 508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition())) 510 continue; 511 512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP)) 513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 514 } 515 } 516 // Check virtual bases. 517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) { 518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public) 519 continue; 520 QualType Ty = I.getType(); 521 if (Ty.isNull()) 522 continue; 523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition())) 525 continue; 526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP)) 527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 528 } 529 } 530 } 531 return nullptr; 532 } 533 534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we 535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important 536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be 537 // different across redeclarations. 538 if (D != OriginalDecl) 539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP); 540 541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D); 542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC; 543 return FC; 544 } 545 546 void 547 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, 548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) { 549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth()); 550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition()); 551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack()); 552 553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters(); 554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size()); 555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(), 556 PEnd = Params->end(); 557 P != PEnd; ++P) { 558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) { 559 ID.AddInteger(0); 560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack()); 561 continue; 562 } 563 564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) { 565 ID.AddInteger(1); 566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack()); 567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr()); 568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) { 569 ID.AddBoolean(true); 570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes()); 571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) { 572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I); 573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr()); 574 } 575 } else 576 ID.AddBoolean(false); 577 continue; 578 } 579 580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P); 581 ID.AddInteger(2); 582 Profile(ID, TTP); 583 } 584 } 585 586 TemplateTemplateParmDecl * 587 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl( 588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const { 589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter. 590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP); 592 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical 594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 595 if (Canonical) 596 return Canonical->getParam(); 597 598 // Build a canonical template parameter list. 599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters(); 600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams; 601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size()); 602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(), 603 PEnd = Params->end(); 604 P != PEnd; ++P) { 605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) 606 CanonParams.push_back( 607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 608 SourceLocation(), 609 SourceLocation(), 610 TTP->getDepth(), 611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false, 612 TTP->isParameterPack())); 613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) { 615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType()); 616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param; 618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) { 619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes; 620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos; 621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) { 622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I))); 623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back( 624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back())); 625 } 626 627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 628 SourceLocation(), 629 SourceLocation(), 630 NTTP->getDepth(), 631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr, 632 T, 633 TInfo, 634 ExpandedTypes.data(), 635 ExpandedTypes.size(), 636 ExpandedTInfos.data()); 637 } else { 638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 639 SourceLocation(), 640 SourceLocation(), 641 NTTP->getDepth(), 642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr, 643 T, 644 NTTP->isParameterPack(), 645 TInfo); 646 } 647 CanonParams.push_back(Param); 648 649 } else 650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl( 651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P))); 652 } 653 654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP 655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(), 657 TTP->getPosition(), 658 TTP->isParameterPack(), 659 nullptr, 660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(), 661 SourceLocation(), 662 CanonParams.data(), 663 CanonParams.size(), 664 SourceLocation())); 665 666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 669 (void)Canonical; 670 671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry. 672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP); 673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos); 674 return CanonTTP; 675 } 676 677 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) { 678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr; 679 680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) { 681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level 682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS: 683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64: 684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: 685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS: 686 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium: 687 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly: 688 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this); 689 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft: 690 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this); 691 } 692 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!"); 693 } 694 695 static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T, 696 const LangOptions &LOpts) { 697 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) { 698 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each 699 // language-specific address space. 700 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = { 701 1, // opencl_global 702 2, // opencl_local 703 3, // opencl_constant 704 4, // opencl_generic 705 5, // cuda_device 706 6, // cuda_constant 707 7 // cuda_shared 708 }; 709 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap; 710 } else { 711 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap(); 712 } 713 } 714 715 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI, 716 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 717 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) { 718 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target: 719 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling(); 720 case LangOptions::ASMM_On: 721 return true; 722 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off: 723 return false; 724 } 725 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything."); 726 } 727 728 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM, 729 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels, 730 Builtin::Context &builtins) 731 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()), 732 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()), 733 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()), 734 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr), 735 UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr), 736 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr), 737 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), 738 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr), 739 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr), 740 FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), 741 ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), 742 BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr), 743 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(), ExternCContext(nullptr), 744 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts), 745 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)), 746 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts), 747 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), BuiltinInfo(builtins), 748 DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr), 749 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false), 750 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) { 751 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this); 752 } 753 754 ASTContext::~ASTContext() { 755 ReleaseParentMapEntries(); 756 757 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects. 758 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution? 759 ReleaseDeclContextMaps(); 760 761 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets. 762 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(), 763 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I) 764 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J) 765 (I->first)((I->second)[J]); 766 767 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed 768 // because they can contain DenseMaps. 769 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*, 770 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator 771 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; ) 772 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory. 773 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second)) 774 R->Destroy(*this); 775 776 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator 777 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) { 778 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory. 779 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second)) 780 R->Destroy(*this); 781 } 782 783 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(), 784 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end(); 785 A != AEnd; ++A) 786 A->second->~AttrVec(); 787 788 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair : 789 MaterializedTemporaryValues) 790 MTVPair.second->~APValue(); 791 792 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts); 793 } 794 795 void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() { 796 if (!AllParents) return; 797 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) { 798 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) { 799 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>(); 800 } else { 801 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()); 802 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>(); 803 } 804 } 805 } 806 807 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) { 808 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data); 809 } 810 811 void 812 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) { 813 ExternalSource = Source; 814 } 815 816 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const { 817 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n"; 818 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n"; 819 820 unsigned counts[] = { 821 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0, 822 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent) 823 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 824 0 // Extra 825 }; 826 827 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) { 828 Type *T = Types[i]; 829 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++; 830 } 831 832 unsigned Idx = 0; 833 unsigned TotalBytes = 0; 834 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) \ 835 if (counts[Idx]) \ 836 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \ 837 << " types\n"; \ 838 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \ 839 ++Idx; 840 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent) 841 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 842 843 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n"; 844 845 // Implicit special member functions. 846 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/" 847 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors 848 << " implicit default constructors created\n"; 849 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/" 850 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors 851 << " implicit copy constructors created\n"; 852 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 853 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/" 854 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors 855 << " implicit move constructors created\n"; 856 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/" 857 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators 858 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n"; 859 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 860 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/" 861 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators 862 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n"; 863 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/" 864 << NumImplicitDestructors 865 << " implicit destructors created\n"; 866 867 if (ExternalSource) { 868 llvm::errs() << "\n"; 869 ExternalSource->PrintStats(); 870 } 871 872 BumpAlloc.PrintStats(); 873 } 874 875 void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M, 876 bool NotifyListeners) { 877 if (NotifyListeners) 878 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener()) 879 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M); 880 881 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 882 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M); 883 else 884 ND->setHidden(false); 885 } 886 887 void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) { 888 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND); 889 if (It == MergedDefModules.end()) 890 return; 891 892 auto &Merged = It->second; 893 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found; 894 for (Module *&M : Merged) 895 if (!Found.insert(M).second) 896 M = nullptr; 897 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end()); 898 } 899 900 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const { 901 if (!ExternCContext) 902 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl()); 903 904 return ExternCContext; 905 } 906 907 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name, 908 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const { 909 SourceLocation Loc; 910 RecordDecl *NewDecl; 911 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 912 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, 913 Loc, &Idents.get(Name)); 914 else 915 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc, 916 &Idents.get(Name)); 917 NewDecl->setImplicit(); 918 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit( 919 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default)); 920 return NewDecl; 921 } 922 923 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T, 924 StringRef Name) const { 925 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 926 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create( 927 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(), 928 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo); 929 NewDecl->setImplicit(); 930 return NewDecl; 931 } 932 933 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const { 934 if (!Int128Decl) 935 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t"); 936 return Int128Decl; 937 } 938 939 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const { 940 if (!UInt128Decl) 941 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t"); 942 return UInt128Decl; 943 } 944 945 TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const { 946 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++"); 947 if (!Float128StubDecl) 948 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128"); 949 950 return Float128StubDecl; 951 } 952 953 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) { 954 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K); 955 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0)); 956 Types.push_back(Ty); 957 } 958 959 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) { 960 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) && 961 "Incorrect target reinitialization"); 962 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?"); 963 964 this->Target = &Target; 965 966 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target)); 967 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts); 968 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts); 969 970 // C99 6.2.5p19. 971 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void); 972 973 // C99 6.2.5p2. 974 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool); 975 // C99 6.2.5p3. 976 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned) 977 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S); 978 else 979 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U); 980 // C99 6.2.5p4. 981 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar); 982 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short); 983 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int); 984 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long); 985 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong); 986 987 // C99 6.2.5p6. 988 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar); 989 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort); 990 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt); 991 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong); 992 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong); 993 994 // C99 6.2.5p10. 995 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float); 996 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double); 997 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble); 998 999 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers. 1000 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128); 1001 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128); 1002 1003 // C++ 3.9.1p5 1004 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType())) 1005 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S); 1006 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned. 1007 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U); 1008 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar) 1009 WideCharTy = WCharTy; 1010 else { 1011 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar). 1012 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType()); 1013 } 1014 1015 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType()); 1016 1017 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++ 1018 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16); 1019 else // C99 1020 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type()); 1021 1022 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++ 1023 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32); 1024 else // C99 1025 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type()); 1026 1027 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is 1028 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against 1029 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to 1030 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent 1031 // expressions. 1032 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent); 1033 1034 // Placeholder type for functions. 1035 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload); 1036 1037 // Placeholder type for bound members. 1038 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember); 1039 1040 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects. 1041 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject); 1042 1043 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients. 1044 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny); 1045 1046 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts. 1047 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast); 1048 1049 // Placeholder type for builtin functions. 1050 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn); 1051 1052 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections. 1053 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 1054 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection); 1055 1056 // C99 6.2.5p11. 1057 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy); 1058 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy); 1059 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy); 1060 1061 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'. 1062 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId); 1063 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass); 1064 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel); 1065 1066 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 1067 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d); 1068 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray); 1069 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer); 1070 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d); 1071 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray); 1072 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth); 1073 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth); 1074 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA); 1075 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA); 1076 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAADepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth); 1077 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepthTy, 1078 BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth); 1079 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d); 1080 1081 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler); 1082 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent); 1083 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent); 1084 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue); 1085 InitBuiltinType(OCLNDRangeTy, BuiltinType::OCLNDRange); 1086 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID); 1087 } 1088 1089 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no 1090 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ? 1091 SignedCharTy : BoolTy); 1092 1093 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType(); 1094 1095 ObjCSuperType = QualType(); 1096 1097 // void * type 1098 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy); 1099 1100 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7) 1101 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr); 1102 1103 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16 1104 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half); 1105 1106 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list. 1107 VaListTagDecl = nullptr; 1108 } 1109 1110 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const { 1111 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics(); 1112 } 1113 1114 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) { 1115 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D]; 1116 if (!Result) { 1117 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec)); 1118 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec; 1119 } 1120 1121 return *Result; 1122 } 1123 1124 /// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration. 1125 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) { 1126 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D); 1127 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) { 1128 Pos->second->~AttrVec(); 1129 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos); 1130 } 1131 } 1132 1133 // FIXME: Remove ? 1134 MemberSpecializationInfo * 1135 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) { 1136 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member"); 1137 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var) 1138 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>(); 1139 } 1140 1141 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo 1142 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) { 1143 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos = 1144 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var); 1145 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end()) 1146 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo(); 1147 1148 return Pos->second; 1149 } 1150 1151 void 1152 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl, 1153 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, 1154 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) { 1155 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member"); 1156 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member"); 1157 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo( 1158 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation)); 1159 } 1160 1161 void 1162 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst, 1163 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) { 1164 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] && 1165 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from"); 1166 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI; 1167 } 1168 1169 FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern( 1170 const FunctionDecl *FD){ 1171 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0"); 1172 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos 1173 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD); 1174 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end()) 1175 return nullptr; 1176 1177 return Pos->second; 1178 } 1179 1180 void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD, 1181 FunctionDecl *Pattern) { 1182 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0"); 1183 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0"); 1184 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern; 1185 } 1186 1187 NamedDecl * 1188 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) { 1189 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos 1190 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD); 1191 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end()) 1192 return nullptr; 1193 1194 return Pos->second; 1195 } 1196 1197 void 1198 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) { 1199 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) || 1200 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) || 1201 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) && 1202 "pattern decl is not a using decl"); 1203 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists"); 1204 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern; 1205 } 1206 1207 UsingShadowDecl * 1208 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) { 1209 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos 1210 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst); 1211 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end()) 1212 return nullptr; 1213 1214 return Pos->second; 1215 } 1216 1217 void 1218 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst, 1219 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) { 1220 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists"); 1221 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern; 1222 } 1223 1224 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) { 1225 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos 1226 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field); 1227 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end()) 1228 return nullptr; 1229 1230 return Pos->second; 1231 } 1232 1233 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst, 1234 FieldDecl *Tmpl) { 1235 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed"); 1236 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed"); 1237 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] && 1238 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from"); 1239 1240 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl; 1241 } 1242 1243 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator 1244 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1245 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos 1246 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl()); 1247 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end()) 1248 return nullptr; 1249 1250 return Pos->second.begin(); 1251 } 1252 1253 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator 1254 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1255 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos 1256 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl()); 1257 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end()) 1258 return nullptr; 1259 1260 return Pos->second.end(); 1261 } 1262 1263 unsigned 1264 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1265 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos 1266 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl()); 1267 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end()) 1268 return 0; 1269 1270 return Pos->second.size(); 1271 } 1272 1273 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method, 1274 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) { 1275 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl()); 1276 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden); 1277 } 1278 1279 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods( 1280 const NamedDecl *D, 1281 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const { 1282 assert(D); 1283 1284 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 1285 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod), 1286 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod)); 1287 return; 1288 } 1289 1290 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D); 1291 if (!Method) 1292 return; 1293 1294 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls; 1295 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls); 1296 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end()); 1297 } 1298 1299 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) { 1300 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain"); 1301 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration"); 1302 if (!FirstLocalImport) { 1303 FirstLocalImport = Import; 1304 LastLocalImport = Import; 1305 return; 1306 } 1307 1308 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import; 1309 LastLocalImport = Import; 1310 } 1311 1312 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1313 // Type Sizing and Analysis 1314 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1315 1316 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified 1317 /// scalar floating point type. 1318 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const { 1319 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1320 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!"); 1321 switch (BT->getKind()) { 1322 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!"); 1323 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat(); 1324 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat(); 1325 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat(); 1326 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat(); 1327 } 1328 } 1329 1330 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const { 1331 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth(); 1332 1333 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false; 1334 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) { 1335 Align = AlignFromAttr; 1336 1337 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment 1338 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases 1339 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified. 1340 // 1341 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can 1342 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it. 1343 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) { 1344 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() || 1345 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 1346 } else { 1347 UseAlignAttrOnly = true; 1348 } 1349 } 1350 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) 1351 UseAlignAttrOnly = 1352 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() || 1353 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 1354 1355 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything 1356 // else about the declaration and its type. 1357 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) { 1358 // do nothing 1359 1360 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) { 1361 QualType T = VD->getType(); 1362 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 1363 if (ForAlignof) 1364 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 1365 else 1366 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType()); 1367 } 1368 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T); 1369 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) { 1370 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the 1371 // large-array alignment on the target. 1372 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) { 1373 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth(); 1374 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) { 1375 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType)) 1376 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign()); 1377 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) && 1378 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType))) 1379 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign()); 1380 } 1381 } 1382 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr())); 1383 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1384 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof) 1385 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign()); 1386 } 1387 } 1388 1389 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if 1390 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a 1391 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate 1392 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then 1393 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type. 1394 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) { 1395 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent(); 1396 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid. 1397 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) { 1398 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent); 1399 1400 // Start with the record's overall alignment. 1401 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment()); 1402 1403 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record. 1404 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex()); 1405 if (Offset > 0) { 1406 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2, 1407 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's. 1408 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1); 1409 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign) 1410 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset); 1411 } 1412 1413 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign); 1414 } 1415 } 1416 } 1417 1418 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align); 1419 } 1420 1421 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in 1422 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is 1423 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type 1424 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator. 1425 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1426 ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const { 1427 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T); 1428 1429 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding 1430 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible 1431 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results. 1432 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1433 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) { 1434 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl()); 1435 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize(); 1436 } 1437 } 1438 1439 return sizeAndAlign; 1440 } 1441 1442 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits 1443 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays. 1444 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1445 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context, 1446 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) { 1447 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo = 1448 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType()); 1449 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 1450 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <= 1451 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) && 1452 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation"); 1453 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size; 1454 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity(); 1455 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() || 1456 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64) 1457 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align); 1458 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width), 1459 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align)); 1460 } 1461 1462 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1463 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const { 1464 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T)) 1465 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT); 1466 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T); 1467 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width), 1468 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align)); 1469 } 1470 1471 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1472 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const { 1473 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr()); 1474 } 1475 1476 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const { 1477 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired; 1478 } 1479 1480 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const { 1481 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr()); 1482 } 1483 1484 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const { 1485 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T); 1486 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end()) 1487 return I->second; 1488 1489 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup. 1490 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T); 1491 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI; 1492 return TI; 1493 } 1494 1495 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This 1496 /// method does not work on incomplete types. 1497 /// 1498 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and 1499 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this 1500 /// should take a QualType, &c. 1501 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const { 1502 uint64_t Width = 0; 1503 unsigned Align = 8; 1504 bool AlignIsRequired = false; 1505 switch (T->getTypeClass()) { 1506 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 1507 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 1508 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 1509 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 1510 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \ 1511 case Type::Class: \ 1512 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \ 1513 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr()); 1514 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 1515 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types"); 1516 1517 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 1518 case Type::FunctionProto: 1519 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits 1520 Width = 0; 1521 Align = 32; 1522 break; 1523 1524 case Type::IncompleteArray: 1525 case Type::VariableArray: 1526 Width = 0; 1527 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType()); 1528 break; 1529 1530 case Type::ConstantArray: { 1531 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T); 1532 1533 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType()); 1534 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 1535 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) && 1536 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation"); 1537 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size; 1538 Align = EltInfo.Align; 1539 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() || 1540 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64) 1541 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align); 1542 break; 1543 } 1544 case Type::ExtVector: 1545 case Type::Vector: { 1546 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T); 1547 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType()); 1548 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements(); 1549 Align = Width; 1550 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2. 1551 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors. 1552 if (Align & (Align-1)) { 1553 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align); 1554 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align); 1555 } 1556 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max. 1557 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign(); 1558 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align) 1559 Align = TargetVectorAlign; 1560 break; 1561 } 1562 1563 case Type::Builtin: 1564 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) { 1565 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!"); 1566 case BuiltinType::Void: 1567 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits. 1568 Width = 0; 1569 Align = 8; 1570 break; 1571 1572 case BuiltinType::Bool: 1573 Width = Target->getBoolWidth(); 1574 Align = Target->getBoolAlign(); 1575 break; 1576 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 1577 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 1578 case BuiltinType::UChar: 1579 case BuiltinType::SChar: 1580 Width = Target->getCharWidth(); 1581 Align = Target->getCharAlign(); 1582 break; 1583 case BuiltinType::WChar_S: 1584 case BuiltinType::WChar_U: 1585 Width = Target->getWCharWidth(); 1586 Align = Target->getWCharAlign(); 1587 break; 1588 case BuiltinType::Char16: 1589 Width = Target->getChar16Width(); 1590 Align = Target->getChar16Align(); 1591 break; 1592 case BuiltinType::Char32: 1593 Width = Target->getChar32Width(); 1594 Align = Target->getChar32Align(); 1595 break; 1596 case BuiltinType::UShort: 1597 case BuiltinType::Short: 1598 Width = Target->getShortWidth(); 1599 Align = Target->getShortAlign(); 1600 break; 1601 case BuiltinType::UInt: 1602 case BuiltinType::Int: 1603 Width = Target->getIntWidth(); 1604 Align = Target->getIntAlign(); 1605 break; 1606 case BuiltinType::ULong: 1607 case BuiltinType::Long: 1608 Width = Target->getLongWidth(); 1609 Align = Target->getLongAlign(); 1610 break; 1611 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 1612 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 1613 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth(); 1614 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign(); 1615 break; 1616 case BuiltinType::Int128: 1617 case BuiltinType::UInt128: 1618 Width = 128; 1619 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets. 1620 break; 1621 case BuiltinType::Half: 1622 Width = Target->getHalfWidth(); 1623 Align = Target->getHalfAlign(); 1624 break; 1625 case BuiltinType::Float: 1626 Width = Target->getFloatWidth(); 1627 Align = Target->getFloatAlign(); 1628 break; 1629 case BuiltinType::Double: 1630 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth(); 1631 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign(); 1632 break; 1633 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: 1634 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth(); 1635 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign(); 1636 break; 1637 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: 1638 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t) 1639 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*) 1640 break; 1641 case BuiltinType::ObjCId: 1642 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass: 1643 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel: 1644 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); 1645 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); 1646 break; 1647 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: 1648 // Samplers are modeled as integers. 1649 Width = Target->getIntWidth(); 1650 Align = Target->getIntAlign(); 1651 break; 1652 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent: 1653 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent: 1654 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue: 1655 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange: 1656 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID: 1657 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d: 1658 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray: 1659 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer: 1660 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d: 1661 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray: 1662 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth: 1663 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth: 1664 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA: 1665 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA: 1666 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth: 1667 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth: 1668 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d: 1669 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types. 1670 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); 1671 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); 1672 break; 1673 } 1674 break; 1675 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 1676 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); 1677 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); 1678 break; 1679 case Type::BlockPointer: { 1680 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace( 1681 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType()); 1682 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1683 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1684 break; 1685 } 1686 case Type::LValueReference: 1687 case Type::RValueReference: { 1688 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go 1689 // the pointer route. 1690 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace( 1691 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType()); 1692 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1693 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1694 break; 1695 } 1696 case Type::Pointer: { 1697 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType()); 1698 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1699 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1700 break; 1701 } 1702 case Type::MemberPointer: { 1703 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T); 1704 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT); 1705 break; 1706 } 1707 case Type::Complex: { 1708 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the 1709 // size. 1710 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType()); 1711 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2; 1712 Align = EltInfo.Align; 1713 break; 1714 } 1715 case Type::ObjCObject: 1716 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr()); 1717 case Type::Adjusted: 1718 case Type::Decayed: 1719 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr()); 1720 case Type::ObjCInterface: { 1721 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T); 1722 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl()); 1723 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize()); 1724 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment()); 1725 break; 1726 } 1727 case Type::Record: 1728 case Type::Enum: { 1729 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T); 1730 1731 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) { 1732 Width = 8; 1733 Align = 8; 1734 break; 1735 } 1736 1737 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) { 1738 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl(); 1739 TypeInfo Info = 1740 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); 1741 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) { 1742 Info.Align = AttrAlign; 1743 Info.AlignIsRequired = true; 1744 } 1745 return Info; 1746 } 1747 1748 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT); 1749 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1750 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD); 1751 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize()); 1752 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment()); 1753 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>(); 1754 break; 1755 } 1756 1757 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 1758 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)-> 1759 getReplacementType().getTypePtr()); 1760 1761 case Type::Auto: { 1762 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T); 1763 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() && 1764 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type"); 1765 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr()); 1766 } 1767 1768 case Type::Paren: 1769 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr()); 1770 1771 case Type::Typedef: { 1772 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl(); 1773 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr()); 1774 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed 1775 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that 1776 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation. 1777 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) { 1778 Align = AttrAlign; 1779 AlignIsRequired = true; 1780 } else { 1781 Align = Info.Align; 1782 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired; 1783 } 1784 Width = Info.Width; 1785 break; 1786 } 1787 1788 case Type::Elaborated: 1789 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr()); 1790 1791 case Type::Attributed: 1792 return getTypeInfo( 1793 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr()); 1794 1795 case Type::Atomic: { 1796 // Start with the base type information. 1797 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType()); 1798 Width = Info.Width; 1799 Align = Info.Align; 1800 1801 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max 1802 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more 1803 // favorable to atomic operations: 1804 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) { 1805 // Round the size up to a power of 2. 1806 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width)) 1807 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width); 1808 1809 // Set the alignment equal to the size. 1810 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width); 1811 } 1812 } 1813 1814 } 1815 1816 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2"); 1817 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired); 1818 } 1819 1820 unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const { 1821 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign(); 1822 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32. 1823 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 || 1824 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) && 1825 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" && 1826 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) 1827 SimdAlign = 256; 1828 return SimdAlign; 1829 } 1830 1831 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters. 1832 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const { 1833 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth()); 1834 } 1835 1836 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters. 1837 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const { 1838 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth(); 1839 } 1840 1841 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters. 1842 /// This method does not work on incomplete types. 1843 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const { 1844 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first; 1845 } 1846 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const { 1847 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first; 1848 } 1849 1850 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in 1851 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types. 1852 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const { 1853 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T)); 1854 } 1855 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const { 1856 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T)); 1857 } 1858 1859 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified 1860 /// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI 1861 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign 1862 /// a data type. 1863 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const { 1864 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T); 1865 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align; 1866 1867 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1868 1869 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer. 1870 if (T->isMemberPointerType()) 1871 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr()); 1872 1873 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore) 1874 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore. 1875 1876 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible. 1877 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>()) 1878 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr(); 1879 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 1880 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr(); 1881 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) || 1882 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) || 1883 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong)) 1884 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a 1885 // typedef declaration. 1886 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired) 1887 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T)); 1888 1889 return ABIAlign; 1890 } 1891 1892 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment 1893 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment 1894 /// value is specified. 1895 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(void) const { 1896 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(); 1897 } 1898 1899 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given 1900 /// to a global variable of the specified type. 1901 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const { 1902 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign()); 1903 } 1904 1905 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that 1906 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type. 1907 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const { 1908 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T)); 1909 } 1910 1911 CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const { 1912 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero(); 1913 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD); 1914 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) { 1915 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base); 1916 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base); 1917 } 1918 return Offset; 1919 } 1920 1921 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars - 1922 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in 1923 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for 1924 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class 1925 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known. 1926 /// 1927 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI, 1928 bool leafClass, 1929 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const { 1930 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass()) 1931 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars); 1932 if (!leafClass) { 1933 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars()) 1934 Ivars.push_back(I); 1935 } else { 1936 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI); 1937 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv; 1938 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar()) 1939 Ivars.push_back(Iv); 1940 } 1941 } 1942 1943 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and 1944 /// those inherited by it. 1945 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl, 1946 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) { 1947 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) { 1948 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of 1949 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories. 1950 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) { 1951 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols); 1952 } 1953 1954 // Categories of this Interface. 1955 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories()) 1956 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols); 1957 1958 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass()) 1959 while (SD) { 1960 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols); 1961 SD = SD->getSuperClass(); 1962 } 1963 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) { 1964 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) { 1965 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols); 1966 } 1967 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) { 1968 // Insert the protocol. 1969 if (!Protocols.insert( 1970 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second) 1971 return; 1972 1973 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) 1974 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols); 1975 } 1976 } 1977 1978 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const { 1979 unsigned count = 0; 1980 // Count ivars declared in class extension. 1981 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions()) 1982 count += Ext->ivar_size(); 1983 1984 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This 1985 // includes synthesized ivars. 1986 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation()) 1987 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size(); 1988 1989 return count; 1990 } 1991 1992 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) { 1993 if (!E) 1994 return false; 1995 1996 // nullptr_t is always treated as null. 1997 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true; 1998 1999 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() && 2000 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this, 2001 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 2002 return true; 2003 2004 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'. 2005 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true; 2006 2007 return false; 2008 } 2009 2010 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists. 2011 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) { 2012 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator 2013 I = ObjCImpls.find(D); 2014 if (I != ObjCImpls.end()) 2015 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second); 2016 return nullptr; 2017 } 2018 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists. 2019 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) { 2020 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator 2021 I = ObjCImpls.find(D); 2022 if (I != ObjCImpls.end()) 2023 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second); 2024 return nullptr; 2025 } 2026 2027 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl. 2028 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD, 2029 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) { 2030 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params"); 2031 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD; 2032 } 2033 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl. 2034 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD, 2035 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) { 2036 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params"); 2037 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD; 2038 } 2039 2040 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface( 2041 const NamedDecl *ND) const { 2042 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = 2043 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext())) 2044 return ID; 2045 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = 2046 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext())) 2047 return CD->getClassInterface(); 2048 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = 2049 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext())) 2050 return IMD->getClassInterface(); 2051 2052 return nullptr; 2053 } 2054 2055 /// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if 2056 /// none exists. 2057 Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) { 2058 assert(VD && "Passed null params"); 2059 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && 2060 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var"); 2061 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator 2062 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD); 2063 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr; 2064 } 2065 2066 /// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl. 2067 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) { 2068 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params"); 2069 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && 2070 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var"); 2071 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init; 2072 } 2073 2074 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T, 2075 unsigned DataSize) const { 2076 if (!DataSize) 2077 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T); 2078 else 2079 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) && 2080 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!"); 2081 2082 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = 2083 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8); 2084 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T); 2085 return TInfo; 2086 } 2087 2088 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T, 2089 SourceLocation L) const { 2090 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T); 2091 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L); 2092 return DI; 2093 } 2094 2095 const ASTRecordLayout & 2096 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const { 2097 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr); 2098 } 2099 2100 const ASTRecordLayout & 2101 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout( 2102 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const { 2103 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D); 2104 } 2105 2106 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 2107 // Type creation/memoization methods 2108 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 2109 2110 QualType 2111 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const { 2112 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers(); 2113 quals.removeFastQualifiers(); 2114 2115 // Check if we've already instantiated this type. 2116 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2117 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals); 2118 void *insertPos = nullptr; 2119 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) { 2120 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals); 2121 return QualType(eq, fastQuals); 2122 } 2123 2124 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type. 2125 QualType canon; 2126 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) { 2127 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split(); 2128 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals); 2129 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals); 2130 2131 // Re-find the insert position. 2132 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 2133 } 2134 2135 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals); 2136 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos); 2137 return QualType(eq, fastQuals); 2138 } 2139 2140 QualType 2141 ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const { 2142 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T); 2143 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace) 2144 return T; 2145 2146 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together 2147 // into one ExtQuals node. 2148 QualifierCollector Quals; 2149 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T); 2150 2151 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get 2152 // another one. 2153 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() && 2154 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!"); 2155 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace); 2156 2157 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals); 2158 } 2159 2160 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T, 2161 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const { 2162 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T); 2163 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr) 2164 return T; 2165 2166 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2167 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType(); 2168 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) { 2169 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr); 2170 return getPointerType(ResultType); 2171 } 2172 } 2173 2174 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together 2175 // into one ExtQuals node. 2176 QualifierCollector Quals; 2177 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T); 2178 2179 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get 2180 // another one. 2181 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() && 2182 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!"); 2183 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr); 2184 2185 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals); 2186 } 2187 2188 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T, 2189 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) { 2190 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info) 2191 return T; 2192 2193 QualType Result; 2194 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) { 2195 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info); 2196 } else { 2197 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T); 2198 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 2199 EPI.ExtInfo = Info; 2200 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 2201 } 2202 2203 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr()); 2204 } 2205 2206 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD, 2207 QualType ResultType) { 2208 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl(); 2209 while (true) { 2210 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2211 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 2212 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 2213 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl()) 2214 FD = Next; 2215 else 2216 break; 2217 } 2218 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener()) 2219 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType); 2220 } 2221 2222 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the 2223 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a 2224 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted 2225 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not. 2226 static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec( 2227 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig, 2228 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) { 2229 // Might have some parens. 2230 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig)) 2231 return Context.getParenType( 2232 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI)); 2233 2234 // Might have a calling-convention attribute. 2235 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig)) 2236 return Context.getAttributedType( 2237 AT->getAttrKind(), 2238 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI), 2239 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(), 2240 ESI)); 2241 2242 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception 2243 // specification. 2244 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig); 2245 return Context.getFunctionType( 2246 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(), 2247 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI)); 2248 } 2249 2250 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec( 2251 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, 2252 bool AsWritten) { 2253 // Update the type. 2254 QualType Updated = 2255 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI); 2256 FD->setType(Updated); 2257 2258 if (!AsWritten) 2259 return; 2260 2261 // Update the type in the type source information too. 2262 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 2263 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update 2264 // the type-as-written too. 2265 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType()) 2266 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI); 2267 2268 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions, 2269 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch 2270 // up the TypeSourceInfo; 2271 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) == 2272 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) && 2273 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification"); 2274 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated); 2275 } 2276 } 2277 2278 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex 2279 /// number with the specified element type. 2280 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const { 2281 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2282 // structure. 2283 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2284 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T); 2285 2286 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2287 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2288 return QualType(CT, 0); 2289 2290 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 2291 // so fill in the canonical type field. 2292 QualType Canonical; 2293 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 2294 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T)); 2295 2296 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2297 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2298 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2299 } 2300 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical); 2301 Types.push_back(New); 2302 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2303 return QualType(New, 0); 2304 } 2305 2306 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to 2307 /// the specified type. 2308 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const { 2309 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2310 // structure. 2311 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2312 PointerType::Profile(ID, T); 2313 2314 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2315 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2316 return QualType(PT, 0); 2317 2318 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 2319 // so fill in the canonical type field. 2320 QualType Canonical; 2321 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 2322 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T)); 2323 2324 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2325 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2326 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2327 } 2328 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical); 2329 Types.push_back(New); 2330 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2331 return QualType(New, 0); 2332 } 2333 2334 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const { 2335 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2336 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New); 2337 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2338 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2339 if (AT) 2340 return QualType(AT, 0); 2341 2342 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New); 2343 2344 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2345 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2346 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 2347 2348 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2349 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical); 2350 Types.push_back(AT); 2351 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos); 2352 return QualType(AT, 0); 2353 } 2354 2355 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const { 2356 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay"); 2357 2358 QualType Decayed; 2359 2360 // C99 6.7.5.3p7: 2361 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be 2362 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type 2363 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of 2364 // the array type derivation. 2365 if (T->isArrayType()) 2366 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T); 2367 2368 // C99 6.7.5.3p8: 2369 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type" 2370 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as 2371 // in 6.3.2.1. 2372 if (T->isFunctionType()) 2373 Decayed = getPointerType(T); 2374 2375 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2376 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed); 2377 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2378 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2379 if (AT) 2380 return QualType(AT, 0); 2381 2382 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed); 2383 2384 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2385 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2386 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 2387 2388 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical); 2389 Types.push_back(AT); 2390 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos); 2391 return QualType(AT, 0); 2392 } 2393 2394 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for 2395 /// a pointer to the specified block. 2396 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const { 2397 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only"); 2398 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular 2399 // structure. 2400 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2401 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T); 2402 2403 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2404 if (BlockPointerType *PT = 2405 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2406 return QualType(PT, 0); 2407 2408 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical 2409 // type either so fill in the canonical type field. 2410 QualType Canonical; 2411 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 2412 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T)); 2413 2414 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2415 BlockPointerType *NewIP = 2416 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2417 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2418 } 2419 BlockPointerType *New 2420 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical); 2421 Types.push_back(New); 2422 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2423 return QualType(New, 0); 2424 } 2425 2426 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an 2427 /// lvalue reference to the specified type. 2428 QualType 2429 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const { 2430 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy && 2431 "Unresolved overloaded function type"); 2432 2433 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2434 // structure. 2435 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2436 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue); 2437 2438 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2439 if (LValueReferenceType *RT = 2440 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2441 return QualType(RT, 0); 2442 2443 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 2444 2445 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 2446 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 2447 QualType Canonical; 2448 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) { 2449 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T); 2450 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType)); 2451 2452 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2453 LValueReferenceType *NewIP = 2454 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2455 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2456 } 2457 2458 LValueReferenceType *New 2459 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical, 2460 SpelledAsLValue); 2461 Types.push_back(New); 2462 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2463 2464 return QualType(New, 0); 2465 } 2466 2467 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an 2468 /// rvalue reference to the specified type. 2469 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const { 2470 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2471 // structure. 2472 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2473 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false); 2474 2475 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2476 if (RValueReferenceType *RT = 2477 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2478 return QualType(RT, 0); 2479 2480 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 2481 2482 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 2483 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 2484 QualType Canonical; 2485 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) { 2486 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T); 2487 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType)); 2488 2489 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2490 RValueReferenceType *NewIP = 2491 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2492 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2493 } 2494 2495 RValueReferenceType *New 2496 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical); 2497 Types.push_back(New); 2498 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2499 return QualType(New, 0); 2500 } 2501 2502 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a 2503 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class. 2504 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const { 2505 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2506 // structure. 2507 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2508 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls); 2509 2510 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2511 if (MemberPointerType *PT = 2512 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2513 return QualType(PT, 0); 2514 2515 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical 2516 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field. 2517 QualType Canonical; 2518 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) { 2519 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls)); 2520 2521 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2522 MemberPointerType *NewIP = 2523 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2524 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2525 } 2526 MemberPointerType *New 2527 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical); 2528 Types.push_back(New); 2529 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2530 return QualType(New, 0); 2531 } 2532 2533 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an 2534 /// array of the specified element type. 2535 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy, 2536 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn, 2537 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 2538 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const { 2539 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() || 2540 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) && 2541 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!"); 2542 2543 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for 2544 // the target. 2545 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn); 2546 ArySize = 2547 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy))); 2548 2549 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2550 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals); 2551 2552 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2553 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP = 2554 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2555 return QualType(ATP, 0); 2556 2557 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't 2558 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field. 2559 QualType Canon; 2560 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 2561 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split(); 2562 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize, 2563 ASM, IndexTypeQuals); 2564 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals); 2565 2566 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2567 ConstantArrayType *NewIP = 2568 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2569 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2570 } 2571 2572 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment) 2573 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals); 2574 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2575 Types.push_back(New); 2576 return QualType(New, 0); 2577 } 2578 2579 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be 2580 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known 2581 /// sizes replaced with [*]. 2582 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const { 2583 // Vastly most common case. 2584 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type; 2585 2586 QualType result; 2587 2588 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType(); 2589 const Type *ty = split.Ty; 2590 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) { 2591 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 2592 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 2593 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 2594 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 2595 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?"); 2596 2597 // These types should never be variably-modified. 2598 case Type::Builtin: 2599 case Type::Complex: 2600 case Type::Vector: 2601 case Type::ExtVector: 2602 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector: 2603 case Type::ObjCObject: 2604 case Type::ObjCInterface: 2605 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 2606 case Type::Record: 2607 case Type::Enum: 2608 case Type::UnresolvedUsing: 2609 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 2610 case Type::TypeOf: 2611 case Type::Decltype: 2612 case Type::UnaryTransform: 2613 case Type::DependentName: 2614 case Type::InjectedClassName: 2615 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 2616 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization: 2617 case Type::TemplateTypeParm: 2618 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack: 2619 case Type::Auto: 2620 case Type::PackExpansion: 2621 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified"); 2622 2623 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to 2624 // further decay. 2625 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 2626 case Type::FunctionProto: 2627 case Type::BlockPointer: 2628 case Type::MemberPointer: 2629 return type; 2630 2631 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications 2632 // preserve structure except as noted by comments. 2633 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op 2634 // optimizations available here. 2635 case Type::Pointer: 2636 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType( 2637 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType())); 2638 break; 2639 2640 case Type::LValueReference: { 2641 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty); 2642 result = getLValueReferenceType( 2643 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()), 2644 lv->isSpelledAsLValue()); 2645 break; 2646 } 2647 2648 case Type::RValueReference: { 2649 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty); 2650 result = getRValueReferenceType( 2651 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType())); 2652 break; 2653 } 2654 2655 case Type::Atomic: { 2656 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty); 2657 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType())); 2658 break; 2659 } 2660 2661 case Type::ConstantArray: { 2662 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty); 2663 result = getConstantArrayType( 2664 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()), 2665 cat->getSize(), 2666 cat->getSizeModifier(), 2667 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); 2668 break; 2669 } 2670 2671 case Type::DependentSizedArray: { 2672 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty); 2673 result = getDependentSizedArrayType( 2674 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()), 2675 dat->getSizeExpr(), 2676 dat->getSizeModifier(), 2677 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 2678 dat->getBracketsRange()); 2679 break; 2680 } 2681 2682 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types. 2683 case Type::IncompleteArray: { 2684 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty); 2685 result = getVariableArrayType( 2686 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()), 2687 /*size*/ nullptr, 2688 ArrayType::Normal, 2689 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 2690 SourceRange()); 2691 break; 2692 } 2693 2694 // Turn VLA types into [*] types. 2695 case Type::VariableArray: { 2696 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty); 2697 result = getVariableArrayType( 2698 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()), 2699 /*size*/ nullptr, 2700 ArrayType::Star, 2701 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 2702 vat->getBracketsRange()); 2703 break; 2704 } 2705 } 2706 2707 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original. 2708 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals); 2709 } 2710 2711 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a 2712 /// variable array of the specified element type. 2713 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy, 2714 Expr *NumElts, 2715 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 2716 unsigned IndexTypeQuals, 2717 SourceRange Brackets) const { 2718 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's 2719 // that have an expression provided for their size. 2720 QualType Canon; 2721 2722 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type. 2723 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 2724 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split(); 2725 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM, 2726 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets); 2727 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals); 2728 } 2729 2730 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment) 2731 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets); 2732 2733 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New); 2734 Types.push_back(New); 2735 return QualType(New, 0); 2736 } 2737 2738 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to 2739 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element 2740 /// type. 2741 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType, 2742 Expr *numElements, 2743 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 2744 unsigned elementTypeQuals, 2745 SourceRange brackets) const { 2746 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() || 2747 numElements->isValueDependent()) && 2748 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!"); 2749 2750 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number 2751 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent 2752 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay 2753 // because they can't be used in most locations. 2754 if (!numElements) { 2755 DependentSizedArrayType *newType 2756 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2757 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(), 2758 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals, 2759 brackets); 2760 Types.push_back(newType); 2761 return QualType(newType, 0); 2762 } 2763 2764 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we 2765 // also build a canonical type. 2766 2767 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split(); 2768 2769 void *insertPos = nullptr; 2770 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2771 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this, 2772 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0), 2773 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements); 2774 2775 // Look for an existing type with these properties. 2776 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy = 2777 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 2778 2779 // If we don't have one, build one. 2780 if (!canonTy) { 2781 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2782 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0), 2783 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals, 2784 brackets); 2785 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos); 2786 Types.push_back(canonTy); 2787 } 2788 2789 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array. 2790 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0), 2791 canonElementType.Quals); 2792 2793 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size 2794 // expression, then just use that as our result. 2795 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType && 2796 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements) 2797 return canon; 2798 2799 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling 2800 // of the element type. 2801 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType 2802 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2803 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements, 2804 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets); 2805 Types.push_back(sugaredType); 2806 return QualType(sugaredType, 0); 2807 } 2808 2809 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType, 2810 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 2811 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const { 2812 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2813 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals); 2814 2815 void *insertPos = nullptr; 2816 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat = 2817 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) 2818 return QualType(iat, 0); 2819 2820 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 2821 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull 2822 // qualifiers off the element type. 2823 QualType canon; 2824 2825 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 2826 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split(); 2827 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), 2828 ASM, elementTypeQuals); 2829 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals); 2830 2831 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2832 IncompleteArrayType *existing = 2833 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 2834 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing; 2835 } 2836 2837 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2838 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals); 2839 2840 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos); 2841 Types.push_back(newType); 2842 return QualType(newType, 0); 2843 } 2844 2845 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of 2846 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type. 2847 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts, 2848 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const { 2849 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType()); 2850 2851 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type. 2852 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2853 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind); 2854 2855 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2856 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2857 return QualType(VTP, 0); 2858 2859 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 2860 // so fill in the canonical type field. 2861 QualType Canonical; 2862 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) { 2863 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind); 2864 2865 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2866 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2867 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2868 } 2869 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2870 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind); 2871 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2872 Types.push_back(New); 2873 return QualType(New, 0); 2874 } 2875 2876 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of 2877 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type. 2878 QualType 2879 ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const { 2880 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType()); 2881 2882 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type. 2883 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2884 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector, 2885 VectorType::GenericVector); 2886 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2887 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2888 return QualType(VTP, 0); 2889 2890 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 2891 // so fill in the canonical type field. 2892 QualType Canonical; 2893 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) { 2894 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts); 2895 2896 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2897 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2898 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2899 } 2900 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2901 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical); 2902 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2903 Types.push_back(New); 2904 return QualType(New, 0); 2905 } 2906 2907 QualType 2908 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType, 2909 Expr *SizeExpr, 2910 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const { 2911 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2912 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType), 2913 SizeExpr); 2914 2915 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2916 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon 2917 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2918 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New; 2919 if (Canon) { 2920 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as 2921 // the canonical type for a newly-built type. 2922 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2923 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0), 2924 SizeExpr, AttrLoc); 2925 } else { 2926 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType); 2927 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) { 2928 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2929 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr, 2930 AttrLoc); 2931 2932 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck 2933 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2934 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken"); 2935 (void)CanonCheck; 2936 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2937 } else { 2938 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr, 2939 SourceLocation()); 2940 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2941 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc); 2942 } 2943 } 2944 2945 Types.push_back(New); 2946 return QualType(New, 0); 2947 } 2948 2949 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'. 2950 /// 2951 QualType 2952 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy, 2953 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const { 2954 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC(); 2955 2956 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular 2957 // structure. 2958 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2959 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info); 2960 2961 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2962 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT = 2963 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2964 return QualType(FT, 0); 2965 2966 QualType Canonical; 2967 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) { 2968 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info); 2969 2970 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2971 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP = 2972 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2973 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2974 } 2975 2976 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv); 2977 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2978 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo); 2979 Types.push_back(New); 2980 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2981 return QualType(New, 0); 2982 } 2983 2984 /// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function. 2985 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) { 2986 return T.isCanonical() && 2987 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None || 2988 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone); 2989 } 2990 2991 QualType 2992 ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray, 2993 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const { 2994 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size(); 2995 2996 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular 2997 // structure. 2998 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2999 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI, 3000 *this); 3001 3002 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3003 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP = 3004 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3005 return QualType(FTP, 0); 3006 3007 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not. 3008 bool isCanonical = 3009 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && 3010 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn; 3011 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i) 3012 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam()) 3013 isCanonical = false; 3014 3015 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it. 3016 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type. 3017 QualType Canonical; 3018 if (!isCanonical) { 3019 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs; 3020 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs); 3021 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i) 3022 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i])); 3023 3024 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI; 3025 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 3026 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo(); 3027 3028 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers. 3029 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy); 3030 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) { 3031 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers(); 3032 Qs.removeObjCLifetime(); 3033 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 3034 } 3035 3036 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI); 3037 3038 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3039 FunctionProtoType *NewIP = 3040 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3041 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3042 } 3043 3044 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after 3045 // them for three variable size arrays at the end: 3046 // - parameter types 3047 // - exception types 3048 // - consumed-arguments flags 3049 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept 3050 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception 3051 // specification. 3052 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) + 3053 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType); 3054 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) { 3055 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType); 3056 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) { 3057 Size += sizeof(Expr*); 3058 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) { 3059 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*); 3060 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) { 3061 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*); 3062 } 3063 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters) 3064 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool); 3065 3066 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment); 3067 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI; 3068 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI); 3069 Types.push_back(FTP); 3070 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos); 3071 return QualType(FTP, 0); 3072 } 3073 3074 #ifndef NDEBUG 3075 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) { 3076 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false; 3077 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 3078 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD)) 3079 return true; 3080 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() && 3081 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD)) 3082 return true; 3083 return false; 3084 } 3085 #endif 3086 3087 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the 3088 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration. 3089 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl, 3090 QualType TST) const { 3091 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl)); 3092 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) { 3093 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl)); 3094 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) { 3095 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type"); 3096 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl; 3097 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl)); 3098 } else { 3099 Type *newType = 3100 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST); 3101 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3102 Types.push_back(newType); 3103 } 3104 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3105 } 3106 3107 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 3108 /// specified type declaration. 3109 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const { 3110 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param"); 3111 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case"); 3112 3113 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl)) 3114 return getTypedefType(Typedef); 3115 3116 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) && 3117 "Template type parameter types are always available."); 3118 3119 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) { 3120 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration"); 3121 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record)); 3122 return getRecordType(Record); 3123 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) { 3124 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration"); 3125 return getEnumType(Enum); 3126 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using = 3127 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) { 3128 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using); 3129 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3130 Types.push_back(newType); 3131 } else 3132 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?"); 3133 3134 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3135 } 3136 3137 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 3138 /// specified typedef name decl. 3139 QualType 3140 ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 3141 QualType Canonical) const { 3142 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3143 3144 if (Canonical.isNull()) 3145 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType()); 3146 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment) 3147 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical); 3148 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3149 Types.push_back(newType); 3150 return QualType(newType, 0); 3151 } 3152 3153 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const { 3154 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3155 3156 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) 3157 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl) 3158 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3159 3160 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl); 3161 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3162 Types.push_back(newType); 3163 return QualType(newType, 0); 3164 } 3165 3166 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const { 3167 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3168 3169 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) 3170 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl) 3171 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3172 3173 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl); 3174 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3175 Types.push_back(newType); 3176 return QualType(newType, 0); 3177 } 3178 3179 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind, 3180 QualType modifiedType, 3181 QualType equivalentType) { 3182 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id; 3183 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType); 3184 3185 void *insertPos = nullptr; 3186 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos); 3187 if (type) return QualType(type, 0); 3188 3189 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType); 3190 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3191 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType); 3192 3193 Types.push_back(type); 3194 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos); 3195 3196 return QualType(type, 0); 3197 } 3198 3199 3200 /// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type. 3201 QualType 3202 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm, 3203 QualType Replacement) const { 3204 assert(Replacement.isCanonical() 3205 && "replacement types must always be canonical"); 3206 3207 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3208 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement); 3209 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3210 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm 3211 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3212 3213 if (!SubstParm) { 3214 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3215 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement); 3216 Types.push_back(SubstParm); 3217 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos); 3218 } 3219 3220 return QualType(SubstParm, 0); 3221 } 3222 3223 /// \brief Retrieve a 3224 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType( 3225 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm, 3226 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) { 3227 #ifndef NDEBUG 3228 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) { 3229 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type"); 3230 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type"); 3231 } 3232 #endif 3233 3234 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3235 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack); 3236 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3237 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm 3238 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3239 return QualType(SubstParm, 0); 3240 3241 QualType Canon; 3242 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) { 3243 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0)); 3244 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon), 3245 ArgPack); 3246 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3247 } 3248 3249 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm 3250 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon, 3251 ArgPack); 3252 Types.push_back(SubstParm); 3253 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos); 3254 return QualType(SubstParm, 0); 3255 } 3256 3257 /// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template 3258 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally) 3259 /// name. 3260 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index, 3261 bool ParameterPack, 3262 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const { 3263 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3264 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl); 3265 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3266 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm 3267 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3268 3269 if (TypeParm) 3270 return QualType(TypeParm, 0); 3271 3272 if (TTPDecl) { 3273 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack); 3274 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon); 3275 3276 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck 3277 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3278 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken"); 3279 (void)TypeCheck; 3280 } else 3281 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3282 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack); 3283 3284 Types.push_back(TypeParm); 3285 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos); 3286 3287 return QualType(TypeParm, 0); 3288 } 3289 3290 TypeSourceInfo * 3291 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name, 3292 SourceLocation NameLoc, 3293 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args, 3294 QualType Underlying) const { 3295 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 3296 "No dependent template names here!"); 3297 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying); 3298 3299 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST); 3300 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL = 3301 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>(); 3302 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 3303 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc); 3304 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc()); 3305 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc()); 3306 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) 3307 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo()); 3308 return DI; 3309 } 3310 3311 QualType 3312 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template, 3313 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args, 3314 QualType Underlying) const { 3315 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 3316 "No dependent template names here!"); 3317 3318 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size(); 3319 3320 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec; 3321 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs); 3322 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i) 3323 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument()); 3324 3325 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs, 3326 Underlying); 3327 } 3328 3329 #ifndef NDEBUG 3330 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args, 3331 unsigned NumArgs) { 3332 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) 3333 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion()) 3334 return true; 3335 3336 return true; 3337 } 3338 #endif 3339 3340 QualType 3341 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template, 3342 const TemplateArgument *Args, 3343 unsigned NumArgs, 3344 QualType Underlying) const { 3345 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 3346 "No dependent template names here!"); 3347 // Look through qualified template names. 3348 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName()) 3349 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl()); 3350 3351 bool IsTypeAlias = 3352 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() && 3353 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl()); 3354 QualType CanonType; 3355 if (!Underlying.isNull()) 3356 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying); 3357 else { 3358 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains 3359 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack. 3360 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) && 3361 "Caller must compute aliased type"); 3362 IsTypeAlias = false; 3363 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, 3364 NumArgs); 3365 } 3366 3367 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't 3368 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that 3369 // we don't unique and don't want to lose. 3370 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) + 3371 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs + 3372 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0), 3373 TypeAlignment); 3374 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec 3375 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType, 3376 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType()); 3377 3378 Types.push_back(Spec); 3379 return QualType(Spec, 0); 3380 } 3381 3382 QualType 3383 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template, 3384 const TemplateArgument *Args, 3385 unsigned NumArgs) const { 3386 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 3387 "No dependent template names here!"); 3388 3389 // Look through qualified template names. 3390 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName()) 3391 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl()); 3392 3393 // Build the canonical template specialization type. 3394 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template); 3395 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs; 3396 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs); 3397 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) 3398 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I])); 3399 3400 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already 3401 // exists. 3402 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3403 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate, 3404 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this); 3405 3406 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3407 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec 3408 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3409 3410 if (!Spec) { 3411 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type. 3412 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) + 3413 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs), 3414 TypeAlignment); 3415 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate, 3416 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, 3417 QualType(), QualType()); 3418 Types.push_back(Spec); 3419 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos); 3420 } 3421 3422 assert(Spec->isDependentType() && 3423 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type"); 3424 return QualType(Spec, 0); 3425 } 3426 3427 QualType 3428 ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 3429 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 3430 QualType NamedType) const { 3431 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3432 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType); 3433 3434 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3435 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3436 if (T) 3437 return QualType(T, 0); 3438 3439 QualType Canon = NamedType; 3440 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) { 3441 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType); 3442 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3443 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken"); 3444 (void)CheckT; 3445 } 3446 3447 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon); 3448 Types.push_back(T); 3449 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 3450 return QualType(T, 0); 3451 } 3452 3453 QualType 3454 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const { 3455 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3456 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType); 3457 3458 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3459 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3460 if (T) 3461 return QualType(T, 0); 3462 3463 QualType Canon = InnerType; 3464 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) { 3465 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType); 3466 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3467 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken"); 3468 (void)CheckT; 3469 } 3470 3471 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon); 3472 Types.push_back(T); 3473 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 3474 return QualType(T, 0); 3475 } 3476 3477 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 3478 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 3479 const IdentifierInfo *Name, 3480 QualType Canon) const { 3481 if (Canon.isNull()) { 3482 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 3483 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword; 3484 if (Keyword == ETK_None) 3485 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename; 3486 3487 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) 3488 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name); 3489 } 3490 3491 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3492 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name); 3493 3494 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3495 DependentNameType *T 3496 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3497 if (T) 3498 return QualType(T, 0); 3499 3500 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon); 3501 Types.push_back(T); 3502 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 3503 return QualType(T, 0); 3504 } 3505 3506 QualType 3507 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType( 3508 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 3509 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 3510 const IdentifierInfo *Name, 3511 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const { 3512 // TODO: avoid this copy 3513 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy; 3514 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I) 3515 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument()); 3516 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, 3517 ArgCopy.size(), 3518 ArgCopy.data()); 3519 } 3520 3521 QualType 3522 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType( 3523 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 3524 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 3525 const IdentifierInfo *Name, 3526 unsigned NumArgs, 3527 const TemplateArgument *Args) const { 3528 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) && 3529 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent"); 3530 3531 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3532 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS, 3533 Name, NumArgs, Args); 3534 3535 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3536 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T 3537 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3538 if (T) 3539 return QualType(T, 0); 3540 3541 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 3542 3543 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword; 3544 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename; 3545 3546 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false; 3547 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs); 3548 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) { 3549 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]); 3550 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I])) 3551 AnyNonCanonArgs = true; 3552 } 3553 3554 QualType Canon; 3555 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) { 3556 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, 3557 Name, NumArgs, 3558 CanonArgs.data()); 3559 3560 // Find the insert position again. 3561 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3562 } 3563 3564 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) + 3565 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs), 3566 TypeAlignment); 3567 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, 3568 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon); 3569 Types.push_back(T); 3570 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 3571 return QualType(T, 0); 3572 } 3573 3574 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern, 3575 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) { 3576 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3577 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions); 3578 3579 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() && 3580 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs"); 3581 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3582 PackExpansionType *T 3583 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3584 if (T) 3585 return QualType(T, 0); 3586 3587 QualType Canon; 3588 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) { 3589 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern); 3590 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it 3591 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its 3592 // parameters. 3593 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) { 3594 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions); 3595 3596 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into 3597 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position. 3598 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3599 } 3600 } 3601 3602 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3603 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions); 3604 Types.push_back(T); 3605 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 3606 return QualType(T, 0); 3607 } 3608 3609 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols 3610 /// alphabetically. 3611 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS, 3612 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) { 3613 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName()); 3614 } 3615 3616 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols, 3617 unsigned NumProtocols) { 3618 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true; 3619 3620 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0]) 3621 return false; 3622 3623 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i) 3624 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 || 3625 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i]) 3626 return false; 3627 return true; 3628 } 3629 3630 static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols, 3631 unsigned &NumProtocols) { 3632 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols; 3633 3634 // Sort protocols, keyed by name. 3635 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd, CmpProtocolNames); 3636 3637 // Canonicalize. 3638 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I) 3639 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl(); 3640 3641 // Remove duplicates. 3642 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd); 3643 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols; 3644 } 3645 3646 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType, 3647 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols, 3648 unsigned NumProtocols) const { 3649 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { }, 3650 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols), 3651 /*isKindOf=*/false); 3652 } 3653 3654 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType( 3655 QualType baseType, 3656 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs, 3657 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, 3658 bool isKindOf) const { 3659 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or 3660 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine. 3661 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf && 3662 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType)) 3663 return baseType; 3664 3665 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 3666 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3667 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf); 3668 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3669 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3670 return QualType(QT, 0); 3671 3672 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization, 3673 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base 3674 // type. 3675 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs; 3676 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) { 3677 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 3678 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs(); 3679 } 3680 3681 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a 3682 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments 3683 // canonicalized. 3684 QualType canonical; 3685 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(), 3686 effectiveTypeArgs.end(), 3687 [&](QualType type) { 3688 return type.isCanonical(); 3689 }); 3690 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols.data(), 3691 protocols.size()); 3692 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) { 3693 // Determine the canonical type arguments. 3694 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs; 3695 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec; 3696 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) { 3697 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size()); 3698 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs) 3699 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg)); 3700 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec; 3701 } else { 3702 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs; 3703 } 3704 3705 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols; 3706 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec; 3707 if (!protocolsSorted) { 3708 canonProtocolsVec.insert(canonProtocolsVec.begin(), 3709 protocols.begin(), 3710 protocols.end()); 3711 unsigned uniqueCount = protocols.size(); 3712 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&canonProtocolsVec[0], uniqueCount); 3713 canonProtocols = llvm::makeArrayRef(&canonProtocolsVec[0], uniqueCount); 3714 } else { 3715 canonProtocols = protocols; 3716 } 3717 3718 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs, 3719 canonProtocols, isKindOf); 3720 3721 // Regenerate InsertPos. 3722 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3723 } 3724 3725 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl); 3726 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType); 3727 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *); 3728 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment); 3729 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T = 3730 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, 3731 isKindOf); 3732 3733 Types.push_back(T); 3734 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 3735 return QualType(T, 0); 3736 } 3737 3738 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's 3739 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol 3740 /// list. 3741 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT, 3742 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) { 3743 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 3744 return false; 3745 3746 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3747 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 3748 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 3749 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false)) 3750 return false; 3751 } 3752 return true; 3753 } 3754 return false; 3755 } 3756 3757 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in 3758 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list 3759 /// of protocols. 3760 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT, 3761 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) { 3762 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 3763 return false; 3764 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3765 if (!OPT) 3766 return false; 3767 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition()) 3768 return false; 3769 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols; 3770 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols); 3771 if (InheritedProtocols.empty()) 3772 return false; 3773 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol 3774 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok. 3775 bool Conforms = false; 3776 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 3777 Conforms = false; 3778 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) { 3779 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) { 3780 Conforms = true; 3781 break; 3782 } 3783 } 3784 if (!Conforms) 3785 break; 3786 } 3787 if (Conforms) 3788 return true; 3789 3790 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) { 3791 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 3792 bool Adopts = false; 3793 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 3794 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto 3795 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto))) 3796 break; 3797 } 3798 if (!Adopts) 3799 return false; 3800 } 3801 return true; 3802 } 3803 3804 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for 3805 /// the given object type. 3806 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const { 3807 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3808 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT); 3809 3810 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3811 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT = 3812 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3813 return QualType(QT, 0); 3814 3815 // Find the canonical object type. 3816 QualType Canonical; 3817 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) { 3818 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT)); 3819 3820 // Regenerate InsertPos. 3821 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3822 } 3823 3824 // No match. 3825 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment); 3826 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType = 3827 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT); 3828 3829 Types.push_back(QType); 3830 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos); 3831 return QualType(QType, 0); 3832 } 3833 3834 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 3835 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional. 3836 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl, 3837 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const { 3838 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) 3839 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3840 3841 if (PrevDecl) { 3842 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl"); 3843 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl; 3844 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3845 } 3846 3847 // Prefer the definition, if there is one. 3848 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition()) 3849 Decl = Def; 3850 3851 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment); 3852 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl); 3853 Decl->TypeForDecl = T; 3854 Types.push_back(T); 3855 return QualType(T, 0); 3856 } 3857 3858 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique 3859 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example, 3860 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different 3861 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates 3862 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique). 3863 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const { 3864 TypeOfExprType *toe; 3865 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) { 3866 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3867 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr); 3868 3869 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3870 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon 3871 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3872 if (Canon) { 3873 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent 3874 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type. 3875 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, 3876 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0)); 3877 } else { 3878 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type. 3879 Canon 3880 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr); 3881 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos); 3882 toe = Canon; 3883 } 3884 } else { 3885 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType()); 3886 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical); 3887 } 3888 Types.push_back(toe); 3889 return QualType(toe, 0); 3890 } 3891 3892 /// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique 3893 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be 3894 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be 3895 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates 3896 /// on canonical types (which are always unique). 3897 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const { 3898 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType); 3899 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical); 3900 Types.push_back(tot); 3901 return QualType(tot, 0); 3902 } 3903 3904 3905 /// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType 3906 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own 3907 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there 3908 /// is an Expr tree under each such type. 3909 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const { 3910 DecltypeType *dt; 3911 3912 // C++11 [temp.type]p2: 3913 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a 3914 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same 3915 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1). 3916 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) { 3917 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3918 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e); 3919 3920 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3921 DependentDecltypeType *Canon 3922 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3923 if (!Canon) { 3924 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type. 3925 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e); 3926 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos); 3927 } 3928 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3929 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0)); 3930 } else { 3931 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3932 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType)); 3933 } 3934 Types.push_back(dt); 3935 return QualType(dt, 0); 3936 } 3937 3938 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory 3939 /// savings are minimal and these are rare. 3940 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType, 3941 QualType UnderlyingType, 3942 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind) 3943 const { 3944 UnaryTransformType *Ty = 3945 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType, 3946 Kind, 3947 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ? 3948 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType)); 3949 Types.push_back(Ty); 3950 return QualType(Ty, 0); 3951 } 3952 3953 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been 3954 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the 3955 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type. 3956 QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto, 3957 bool IsDependent) const { 3958 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent) 3959 return getAutoDeductType(); 3960 3961 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 3962 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3963 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3964 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent); 3965 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3966 return QualType(AT, 0); 3967 3968 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType, 3969 IsDecltypeAuto, 3970 IsDependent); 3971 Types.push_back(AT); 3972 if (InsertPos) 3973 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos); 3974 return QualType(AT, 0); 3975 } 3976 3977 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for 3978 /// the given value type. 3979 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const { 3980 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 3981 // structure. 3982 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3983 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T); 3984 3985 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3986 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3987 return QualType(AT, 0); 3988 3989 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 3990 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 3991 QualType Canonical; 3992 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 3993 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T)); 3994 3995 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3996 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3997 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3998 } 3999 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical); 4000 Types.push_back(New); 4001 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 4002 return QualType(New, 0); 4003 } 4004 4005 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'. 4006 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const { 4007 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull()) 4008 AutoDeductTy = QualType( 4009 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false, 4010 /*dependent*/false), 4011 0); 4012 return AutoDeductTy; 4013 } 4014 4015 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'. 4016 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const { 4017 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull()) 4018 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType()); 4019 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern"); 4020 return AutoRRefDeductTy; 4021 } 4022 4023 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 4024 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl. 4025 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const { 4026 assert (Decl); 4027 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting 4028 // away const? mutable? 4029 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl)); 4030 } 4031 4032 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result 4033 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and 4034 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>. 4035 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const { 4036 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType()); 4037 } 4038 4039 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5). 4040 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const { 4041 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType()); 4042 } 4043 4044 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5). 4045 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const { 4046 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType()); 4047 } 4048 4049 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t". 4050 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension. 4051 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const { 4052 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ? 4053 return WCharTy; 4054 } 4055 4056 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t". 4057 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension. 4058 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const { 4059 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ? 4060 return UnsignedIntTy; 4061 } 4062 4063 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const { 4064 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType()); 4065 } 4066 4067 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const { 4068 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType()); 4069 } 4070 4071 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17) 4072 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9). 4073 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const { 4074 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0)); 4075 } 4076 4077 /// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in 4078 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork(). 4079 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const { 4080 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType()); 4081 } 4082 4083 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4084 // Type Operators 4085 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4086 4087 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const { 4088 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining 4089 // qualifiers. 4090 T = getCanonicalType(T); 4091 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T); 4092 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr(); 4093 QualType Result; 4094 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) { 4095 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0)); 4096 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) { 4097 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0)); 4098 } else { 4099 Result = QualType(Ty, 0); 4100 } 4101 4102 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result); 4103 } 4104 4105 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type, 4106 Qualifiers &quals) { 4107 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType(); 4108 4109 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to 4110 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor. 4111 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with 4112 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly. 4113 const ArrayType *AT = 4114 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); 4115 4116 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType. 4117 if (!AT) { 4118 quals = splitType.Quals; 4119 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0); 4120 } 4121 4122 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type. 4123 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType(); 4124 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals); 4125 4126 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we 4127 // can just use the results in splitType. 4128 if (elementType == unqualElementType) { 4129 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call 4130 quals = splitType.Quals; 4131 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0); 4132 } 4133 4134 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then 4135 // build the type back up. 4136 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals); 4137 4138 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) { 4139 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(), 4140 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0); 4141 } 4142 4143 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) { 4144 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0); 4145 } 4146 4147 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) { 4148 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType, 4149 VAT->getSizeExpr(), 4150 VAT->getSizeModifier(), 4151 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 4152 VAT->getBracketsRange()); 4153 } 4154 4155 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT); 4156 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(), 4157 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0, 4158 SourceRange()); 4159 } 4160 4161 /// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that 4162 /// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that 4163 /// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types 4164 /// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this 4165 /// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level 4166 /// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically 4167 /// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and 4168 /// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level. 4169 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) { 4170 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(), 4171 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>(); 4172 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) { 4173 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType(); 4174 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType(); 4175 return true; 4176 } 4177 4178 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(), 4179 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4180 if (T1MPType && T2MPType && 4181 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0), 4182 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) { 4183 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType(); 4184 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType(); 4185 return true; 4186 } 4187 4188 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) { 4189 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 4190 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4191 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) { 4192 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType(); 4193 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType(); 4194 return true; 4195 } 4196 } 4197 4198 // FIXME: Block pointers, too? 4199 4200 return false; 4201 } 4202 4203 DeclarationNameInfo 4204 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name, 4205 SourceLocation NameLoc) const { 4206 switch (Name.getKind()) { 4207 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate: 4208 case TemplateName::Template: 4209 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc? 4210 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(), 4211 NameLoc); 4212 4213 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: { 4214 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate(); 4215 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc? 4216 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc); 4217 } 4218 4219 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: { 4220 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName(); 4221 DeclarationName DName; 4222 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) { 4223 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier()); 4224 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc); 4225 } else { 4226 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator()); 4227 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations? 4228 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc; 4229 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding(); 4230 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding(); 4231 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc); 4232 } 4233 } 4234 4235 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: { 4236 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst 4237 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm(); 4238 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(), 4239 NameLoc); 4240 } 4241 4242 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: { 4243 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst 4244 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(); 4245 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(), 4246 NameLoc); 4247 } 4248 } 4249 4250 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!"); 4251 } 4252 4253 TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const { 4254 switch (Name.getKind()) { 4255 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate: 4256 case TemplateName::Template: { 4257 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 4258 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP 4259 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template)) 4260 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP); 4261 4262 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration. 4263 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl())); 4264 } 4265 4266 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: 4267 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template"); 4268 4269 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: { 4270 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName(); 4271 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls."); 4272 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName; 4273 } 4274 4275 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: { 4276 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst 4277 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm(); 4278 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement()); 4279 } 4280 4281 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: { 4282 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst 4283 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(); 4284 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter 4285 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack()); 4286 TemplateArgument canonArgPack 4287 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack()); 4288 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack); 4289 } 4290 } 4291 4292 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!"); 4293 } 4294 4295 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) { 4296 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X); 4297 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y); 4298 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer(); 4299 } 4300 4301 TemplateArgument 4302 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const { 4303 switch (Arg.getKind()) { 4304 case TemplateArgument::Null: 4305 return Arg; 4306 4307 case TemplateArgument::Expression: 4308 return Arg; 4309 4310 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: { 4311 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 4312 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl()); 4313 } 4314 4315 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr: 4316 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()), 4317 /*isNullPtr*/true); 4318 4319 case TemplateArgument::Template: 4320 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate())); 4321 4322 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion: 4323 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName( 4324 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()), 4325 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions()); 4326 4327 case TemplateArgument::Integral: 4328 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType())); 4329 4330 case TemplateArgument::Type: 4331 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType())); 4332 4333 case TemplateArgument::Pack: { 4334 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0) 4335 return Arg; 4336 4337 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs 4338 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()]; 4339 unsigned Idx = 0; 4340 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(), 4341 AEnd = Arg.pack_end(); 4342 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx) 4343 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A); 4344 4345 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size())); 4346 } 4347 } 4348 4349 // Silence GCC warning 4350 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind"); 4351 } 4352 4353 NestedNameSpecifier * 4354 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const { 4355 if (!NNS) 4356 return nullptr; 4357 4358 switch (NNS->getKind()) { 4359 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier: 4360 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same. 4361 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 4362 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()), 4363 NNS->getAsIdentifier()); 4364 4365 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace: 4366 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with 4367 // this namespace and no prefix. 4368 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, 4369 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace()); 4370 4371 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias: 4372 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with 4373 // this namespace and no prefix. 4374 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, 4375 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace() 4376 ->getOriginalNamespace()); 4377 4378 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: 4379 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: { 4380 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0)); 4381 4382 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"), 4383 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those 4384 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize 4385 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name 4386 // types, e.g., 4387 // typedef typename T::type T1; 4388 // typedef typename T1::type T2; 4389 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>()) 4390 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(), 4391 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier())); 4392 4393 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec. 4394 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the 4395 // first place? 4396 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false, 4397 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr())); 4398 } 4399 4400 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global: 4401 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super: 4402 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique. 4403 return NNS; 4404 } 4405 4406 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!"); 4407 } 4408 4409 4410 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const { 4411 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently. 4412 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 4413 // Handle the common positive case fast. 4414 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T)) 4415 return AT; 4416 } 4417 4418 // Handle the common negative case fast. 4419 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType())) 4420 return nullptr; 4421 4422 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This 4423 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes 4424 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type." 4425 4426 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have 4427 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type 4428 // we must propagate them down into the element type. 4429 4430 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType(); 4431 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals; 4432 4433 // If we have a simple case, just return now. 4434 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty); 4435 if (!ATy || qs.empty()) 4436 return ATy; 4437 4438 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the 4439 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type. 4440 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs); 4441 4442 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy)) 4443 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(), 4444 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 4445 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers())); 4446 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy)) 4447 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy, 4448 IAT->getSizeModifier(), 4449 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers())); 4450 4451 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT 4452 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy)) 4453 return cast<ArrayType>( 4454 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy, 4455 DSAT->getSizeExpr(), 4456 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 4457 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 4458 DSAT->getBracketsRange())); 4459 4460 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy); 4461 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy, 4462 VAT->getSizeExpr(), 4463 VAT->getSizeModifier(), 4464 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 4465 VAT->getBracketsRange())); 4466 } 4467 4468 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const { 4469 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) 4470 return getDecayedType(T); 4471 return T; 4472 } 4473 4474 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const { 4475 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T); 4476 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T); 4477 return T.getUnqualifiedType(); 4478 } 4479 4480 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const { 4481 // C++ [except.throw]p3: 4482 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception 4483 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level 4484 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting 4485 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T" 4486 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...] 4487 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T); 4488 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) 4489 T = getDecayedType(T); 4490 return T.getUnqualifiedType(); 4491 } 4492 4493 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the 4494 /// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when 4495 /// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type, 4496 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array. 4497 /// 4498 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3. 4499 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const { 4500 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any 4501 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation 4502 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present 4503 // (C99 6.7.3p8). 4504 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty); 4505 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!"); 4506 4507 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType()); 4508 4509 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict 4510 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers()); 4511 } 4512 4513 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const { 4514 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType()); 4515 } 4516 4517 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const { 4518 Qualifiers qs; 4519 while (true) { 4520 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType(); 4521 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe(); 4522 if (!array) break; 4523 4524 type = array->getElementType(); 4525 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals); 4526 } 4527 4528 return getQualifiedType(type, qs); 4529 } 4530 4531 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements. 4532 uint64_t 4533 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const { 4534 uint64_t ElementCount = 1; 4535 do { 4536 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4537 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>( 4538 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()); 4539 } while (CA); 4540 return ElementCount; 4541 } 4542 4543 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types. 4544 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float. 4545 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) { 4546 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4547 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType()); 4548 4549 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type"); 4550 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) { 4551 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type"); 4552 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank; 4553 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank; 4554 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank; 4555 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank; 4556 } 4557 } 4558 4559 /// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating 4560 /// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize). 4561 /// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type. 4562 /// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type. 4563 QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size, 4564 QualType Domain) const { 4565 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size); 4566 if (Domain->isComplexType()) { 4567 switch (EltRank) { 4568 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported"); 4569 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy; 4570 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy; 4571 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy; 4572 } 4573 } 4574 4575 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!"); 4576 switch (EltRank) { 4577 case HalfRank: return HalfTy; 4578 case FloatRank: return FloatTy; 4579 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy; 4580 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy; 4581 } 4582 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank"); 4583 } 4584 4585 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating 4586 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' == 4587 /// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If 4588 /// LHS < RHS, return -1. 4589 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const { 4590 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS); 4591 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS); 4592 4593 if (LHSR == RHSR) 4594 return 0; 4595 if (LHSR > RHSR) 4596 return 1; 4597 return -1; 4598 } 4599 4600 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This 4601 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum, 4602 /// or if it is not canonicalized. 4603 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const { 4604 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized"); 4605 4606 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) { 4607 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer"); 4608 case BuiltinType::Bool: 4609 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3); 4610 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 4611 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 4612 case BuiltinType::SChar: 4613 case BuiltinType::UChar: 4614 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3); 4615 case BuiltinType::Short: 4616 case BuiltinType::UShort: 4617 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3); 4618 case BuiltinType::Int: 4619 case BuiltinType::UInt: 4620 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3); 4621 case BuiltinType::Long: 4622 case BuiltinType::ULong: 4623 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3); 4624 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 4625 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 4626 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3); 4627 case BuiltinType::Int128: 4628 case BuiltinType::UInt128: 4629 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3); 4630 } 4631 } 4632 4633 /// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according 4634 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions). 4635 /// 4636 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no 4637 /// promotion occurs. 4638 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const { 4639 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent()) 4640 return QualType(); 4641 4642 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This 4643 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various 4644 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator. 4645 4646 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields? 4647 if (!Field) 4648 return QualType(); 4649 4650 QualType FT = Field->getType(); 4651 4652 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this); 4653 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy); 4654 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 4655 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type 4656 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it 4657 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the 4658 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral 4659 // promotion applies to it. 4660 // C11 6.3.1.1/2: 4661 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:] 4662 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by 4663 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise, 4664 // it is converted to an unsigned int. 4665 // 4666 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int. 4667 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++. 4668 if (BitWidth < IntSize) 4669 return IntTy; 4670 4671 if (BitWidth == IntSize) 4672 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy; 4673 4674 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act 4675 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we 4676 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to 4677 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks 4678 // into their semantics in some cases). 4679 return QualType(); 4680 } 4681 4682 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will 4683 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable 4684 /// integer type. 4685 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const { 4686 assert(!Promotable.isNull()); 4687 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType()); 4688 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>()) 4689 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType(); 4690 4691 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 4692 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t 4693 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following 4694 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type: 4695 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or 4696 // unsigned long long int [...] 4697 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this? 4698 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S || 4699 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U || 4700 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 || 4701 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) { 4702 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S; 4703 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT); 4704 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy, 4705 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy }; 4706 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) { 4707 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 4708 if (FromSize < ToSize || 4709 (FromSize == ToSize && 4710 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) 4711 return PromoteTypes[Idx]; 4712 } 4713 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long"); 4714 } 4715 } 4716 4717 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type. 4718 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType()) 4719 return IntTy; 4720 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable); 4721 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy); 4722 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize); 4723 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy; 4724 } 4725 4726 /// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable 4727 /// type and returns its ownership. 4728 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const { 4729 while (!T.isNull()) { 4730 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None) 4731 return T.getObjCLifetime(); 4732 if (T->isArrayType()) 4733 T = getBaseElementType(T); 4734 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>()) 4735 T = PT->getPointeeType(); 4736 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 4737 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 4738 else 4739 break; 4740 } 4741 4742 return Qualifiers::OCL_None; 4743 } 4744 4745 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) { 4746 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types. 4747 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types. 4748 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped()) 4749 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr(); 4750 return nullptr; 4751 } 4752 4753 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type: 4754 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If 4755 /// LHS < RHS, return -1. 4756 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const { 4757 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr(); 4758 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr(); 4759 4760 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type. 4761 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC)) 4762 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET); 4763 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC)) 4764 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET); 4765 4766 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0; 4767 4768 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 4769 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 4770 4771 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC); 4772 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC); 4773 4774 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned. 4775 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0; 4776 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1; 4777 } 4778 4779 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa. 4780 if (LHSUnsigned) { 4781 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it. 4782 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank) 4783 return 1; 4784 4785 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it 4786 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are 4787 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe. 4788 return -1; 4789 } 4790 4791 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it. 4792 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank) 4793 return -1; 4794 4795 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it 4796 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are 4797 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe. 4798 return 1; 4799 } 4800 4801 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings. 4802 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const { 4803 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) { 4804 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString"); 4805 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition(); 4806 4807 QualType FieldTypes[4]; 4808 4809 // const int *isa; 4810 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst()); 4811 // int flags; 4812 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy; 4813 // const char *str; 4814 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()); 4815 // long length; 4816 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy; 4817 4818 // Create fields 4819 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) { 4820 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl, 4821 SourceLocation(), 4822 SourceLocation(), nullptr, 4823 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 4824 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 4825 /*Mutable=*/false, 4826 ICIS_NoInit); 4827 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 4828 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field); 4829 } 4830 4831 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition(); 4832 } 4833 4834 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl); 4835 } 4836 4837 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const { 4838 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) { 4839 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super"); 4840 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl); 4841 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl); 4842 } 4843 return ObjCSuperType; 4844 } 4845 4846 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) { 4847 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 4848 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType"); 4849 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl(); 4850 } 4851 4852 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const { 4853 if (BlockDescriptorType) 4854 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType); 4855 4856 RecordDecl *RD; 4857 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit. 4858 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor"); 4859 RD->startDefinition(); 4860 4861 QualType FieldTypes[] = { 4862 UnsignedLongTy, 4863 UnsignedLongTy, 4864 }; 4865 4866 static const char *const FieldNames[] = { 4867 "reserved", 4868 "Size" 4869 }; 4870 4871 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) { 4872 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create( 4873 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), 4874 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 4875 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit); 4876 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 4877 RD->addDecl(Field); 4878 } 4879 4880 RD->completeDefinition(); 4881 4882 BlockDescriptorType = RD; 4883 4884 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType); 4885 } 4886 4887 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const { 4888 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType) 4889 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType); 4890 4891 RecordDecl *RD; 4892 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit. 4893 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose"); 4894 RD->startDefinition(); 4895 4896 QualType FieldTypes[] = { 4897 UnsignedLongTy, 4898 UnsignedLongTy, 4899 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy), 4900 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy) 4901 }; 4902 4903 static const char *const FieldNames[] = { 4904 "reserved", 4905 "Size", 4906 "CopyFuncPtr", 4907 "DestroyFuncPtr" 4908 }; 4909 4910 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) { 4911 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create( 4912 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), 4913 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 4914 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 4915 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit); 4916 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 4917 RD->addDecl(Field); 4918 } 4919 4920 RD->completeDefinition(); 4921 4922 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD; 4923 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType); 4924 } 4925 4926 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty" 4927 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic 4928 /// in buildByrefHelpers. 4929 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty, 4930 const VarDecl *D) { 4931 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 4932 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D); 4933 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false; 4934 4935 return true; 4936 } 4937 4938 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false; 4939 4940 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers(); 4941 4942 // If we have lifetime, that dominates. 4943 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) { 4944 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 4945 4946 switch (lifetime) { 4947 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible"); 4948 4949 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned. 4950 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 4951 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 4952 return false; 4953 4954 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the 4955 // byref routines. 4956 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 4957 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained. 4958 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 4959 return true; 4960 } 4961 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!"); 4962 } 4963 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) || 4964 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 4965 } 4966 4967 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty, 4968 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime, 4969 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const { 4970 4971 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 || 4972 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 4973 return false; 4974 4975 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false; 4976 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 4977 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true; 4978 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None; 4979 } 4980 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 4981 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime(); 4982 // MRR. 4983 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) 4984 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 4985 else 4986 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None; 4987 return true; 4988 } 4989 4990 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() { 4991 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl) 4992 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl = 4993 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype"); 4994 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl; 4995 } 4996 4997 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL: 4998 // typedef <type> BOOL; 4999 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) { 5000 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T)) 5001 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 5002 return II->isStr("BOOL"); 5003 5004 return false; 5005 } 5006 5007 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding 5008 /// purpose. 5009 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const { 5010 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType()) 5011 return CharUnits::Zero(); 5012 5013 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type); 5014 5015 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int 5016 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 5017 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy)); 5018 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in. 5019 else if (type->isArrayType()) 5020 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy); 5021 return sz; 5022 } 5023 5024 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const { 5025 return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() && 5026 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 5027 VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isOutOfLine() && VD->hasInit(); 5028 } 5029 5030 static inline 5031 std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) { 5032 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity()); 5033 } 5034 5035 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block 5036 /// declaration. 5037 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const { 5038 std::string S; 5039 5040 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl(); 5041 QualType BlockTy = 5042 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5043 // Encode result type. 5044 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig) 5045 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter( 5046 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S, 5047 true /*Extended*/); 5048 else 5049 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S); 5050 // Compute size of all parameters. 5051 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes. 5052 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation! 5053 SourceLocation Loc; 5054 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy); 5055 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize; 5056 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) { 5057 QualType PType = PI->getType(); 5058 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 5059 if (sz.isZero()) 5060 continue; 5061 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type"); 5062 ParmOffset += sz; 5063 } 5064 // Size of the argument frame 5065 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 5066 // Block pointer and offset. 5067 S += "@?0"; 5068 5069 // Argument types. 5070 ParmOffset = PtrSize; 5071 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) { 5072 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType(); 5073 if (const ArrayType *AT = 5074 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) { 5075 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of 5076 // elements. 5077 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 5078 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 5079 } else if (PType->isFunctionType()) 5080 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 5081 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig) 5082 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType, 5083 S, true /*Extended*/); 5084 else 5085 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S); 5086 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 5087 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 5088 } 5089 5090 return S; 5091 } 5092 5093 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl, 5094 std::string& S) { 5095 // Encode result type. 5096 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S); 5097 CharUnits ParmOffset; 5098 // Compute size of all parameters. 5099 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) { 5100 QualType PType = PI->getType(); 5101 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 5102 if (sz.isZero()) 5103 continue; 5104 5105 assert (sz.isPositive() && 5106 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type"); 5107 ParmOffset += sz; 5108 } 5109 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 5110 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero(); 5111 5112 // Argument types. 5113 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) { 5114 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType(); 5115 if (const ArrayType *AT = 5116 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) { 5117 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of 5118 // elements. 5119 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 5120 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 5121 } else if (PType->isFunctionType()) 5122 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 5123 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S); 5124 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 5125 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 5126 } 5127 5128 return false; 5129 } 5130 5131 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single 5132 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and 5133 /// block object types. 5134 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT, 5135 QualType T, std::string& S, 5136 bool Extended) const { 5137 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter. 5138 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S); 5139 // Encode parameter type. 5140 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr, 5141 true /*OutermostType*/, 5142 false /*EncodingProperty*/, 5143 false /*StructField*/, 5144 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/, 5145 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/); 5146 } 5147 5148 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method 5149 /// declaration. 5150 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl, 5151 std::string& S, 5152 bool Extended) const { 5153 // FIXME: This is not very efficient. 5154 // Encode return type. 5155 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(), 5156 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended); 5157 // Compute size of all parameters. 5158 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes. 5159 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation! 5160 SourceLocation Loc; 5161 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy); 5162 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for 5163 // their size. 5164 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize; 5165 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), 5166 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) { 5167 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType(); 5168 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 5169 if (sz.isZero()) 5170 continue; 5171 5172 assert (sz.isPositive() && 5173 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type"); 5174 ParmOffset += sz; 5175 } 5176 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 5177 S += "@0:"; 5178 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize); 5179 5180 // Argument types. 5181 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize; 5182 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), 5183 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) { 5184 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI; 5185 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType(); 5186 if (const ArrayType *AT = 5187 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) { 5188 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of 5189 // elements. 5190 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 5191 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 5192 } else if (PType->isFunctionType()) 5193 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 5194 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(), 5195 PType, S, Extended); 5196 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 5197 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 5198 } 5199 5200 return false; 5201 } 5202 5203 ObjCPropertyImplDecl * 5204 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl( 5205 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD, 5206 const Decl *Container) const { 5207 if (!Container) 5208 return nullptr; 5209 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID = 5210 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) { 5211 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls()) 5212 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) 5213 return PID; 5214 } else { 5215 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container); 5216 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls()) 5217 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) 5218 return PID; 5219 } 5220 return nullptr; 5221 } 5222 5223 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this 5224 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an 5225 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be 5226 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties. 5227 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple 5228 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The 5229 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are 5230 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types 5231 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode 5232 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration: 5233 /// @code 5234 /// enum PropertyAttributes { 5235 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only. 5236 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned 5237 /// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned 5238 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic 5239 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name 5240 /// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name 5241 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name 5242 /// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding. 5243 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property 5244 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able 5245 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic 5246 /// }; 5247 /// @endcode 5248 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD, 5249 const Decl *Container, 5250 std::string& S) const { 5251 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s). 5252 bool Dynamic = false; 5253 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr; 5254 5255 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl = 5256 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) { 5257 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) 5258 Dynamic = true; 5259 else 5260 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl; 5261 } 5262 5263 // FIXME: This is not very efficient. 5264 S = "T"; 5265 5266 // Encode result type. 5267 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which 5268 // closely resembles encoding of ivars. 5269 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S); 5270 5271 if (PD->isReadOnly()) { 5272 S += ",R"; 5273 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy) 5274 S += ",C"; 5275 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain) 5276 S += ",&"; 5277 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak) 5278 S += ",W"; 5279 } else { 5280 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) { 5281 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break; 5282 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break; 5283 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break; 5284 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break; 5285 } 5286 } 5287 5288 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties 5289 // are "dynamic by default". 5290 if (Dynamic) 5291 S += ",D"; 5292 5293 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic) 5294 S += ",N"; 5295 5296 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) { 5297 S += ",G"; 5298 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString(); 5299 } 5300 5301 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) { 5302 S += ",S"; 5303 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString(); 5304 } 5305 5306 if (SynthesizePID) { 5307 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl(); 5308 S += ",V"; 5309 S += OID->getNameAsString(); 5310 } 5311 5312 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong 5313 } 5314 5315 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding - 5316 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as 5317 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use 5318 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer! 5319 /// 5320 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const { 5321 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) { 5322 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 5323 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32) 5324 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy; 5325 else 5326 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32) 5327 PointeeTy = IntTy; 5328 } 5329 } 5330 } 5331 5332 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S, 5333 const FieldDecl *Field, 5334 QualType *NotEncodedT) const { 5335 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are 5336 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that 5337 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the 5338 // same type. 5339 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field, 5340 true /* outermost type */, false, false, 5341 false, false, false, NotEncodedT); 5342 } 5343 5344 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T, 5345 std::string& S) const { 5346 // Encode result type. 5347 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which 5348 // closely resembles encoding of ivars. 5349 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr, 5350 true /* outermost type */, 5351 true /* encoding property */); 5352 } 5353 5354 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C, 5355 BuiltinType::Kind kind) { 5356 switch (kind) { 5357 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v'; 5358 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B'; 5359 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 5360 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C'; 5361 case BuiltinType::Char16: 5362 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S'; 5363 case BuiltinType::Char32: 5364 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I'; 5365 case BuiltinType::ULong: 5366 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q'; 5367 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T'; 5368 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q'; 5369 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 5370 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c'; 5371 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's'; 5372 case BuiltinType::WChar_S: 5373 case BuiltinType::WChar_U: 5374 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i'; 5375 case BuiltinType::Long: 5376 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q'; 5377 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q'; 5378 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't'; 5379 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f'; 5380 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd'; 5381 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D'; 5382 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char* 5383 5384 case BuiltinType::Half: 5385 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these! 5386 return ' '; 5387 5388 case BuiltinType::ObjCId: 5389 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass: 5390 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel: 5391 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type"); 5392 5393 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings. 5394 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d: 5395 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray: 5396 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer: 5397 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d: 5398 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray: 5399 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth: 5400 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth: 5401 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA: 5402 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA: 5403 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth: 5404 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth: 5405 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d: 5406 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent: 5407 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent: 5408 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue: 5409 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange: 5410 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID: 5411 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: 5412 case BuiltinType::Dependent: 5413 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID) 5414 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \ 5415 case BuiltinType::KIND: 5416 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 5417 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode"); 5418 } 5419 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value"); 5420 } 5421 5422 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) { 5423 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl(); 5424 5425 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size. 5426 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 5427 return 'i'; 5428 5429 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type. 5430 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>(); 5431 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind()); 5432 } 5433 5434 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S, 5435 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) { 5436 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl"); 5437 S += 'b'; 5438 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits. 5439 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b, 5440 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the 5441 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure: 5442 // 5443 // struct 5444 // { 5445 // int integer; 5446 // int flags:2; 5447 // }; 5448 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT 5449 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra 5450 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for 5451 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that 5452 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes... 5453 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) { 5454 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent(); 5455 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD); 5456 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex())); 5457 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 5458 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET); 5459 else { 5460 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>(); 5461 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind()); 5462 } 5463 } 5464 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx)); 5465 } 5466 5467 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string. 5468 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S, 5469 bool ExpandPointedToStructures, 5470 bool ExpandStructures, 5471 const FieldDecl *FD, 5472 bool OutermostType, 5473 bool EncodingProperty, 5474 bool StructField, 5475 bool EncodeBlockParameters, 5476 bool EncodeClassNames, 5477 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef, 5478 QualType *NotEncodedT) const { 5479 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T); 5480 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) { 5481 case Type::Builtin: 5482 case Type::Enum: 5483 if (FD && FD->isBitField()) 5484 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD); 5485 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT)) 5486 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind()); 5487 else 5488 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT)); 5489 return; 5490 5491 case Type::Complex: { 5492 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>(); 5493 S += 'j'; 5494 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr); 5495 return; 5496 } 5497 5498 case Type::Atomic: { 5499 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>(); 5500 S += 'A'; 5501 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr); 5502 return; 5503 } 5504 5505 // encoding for pointer or reference types. 5506 case Type::Pointer: 5507 case Type::LValueReference: 5508 case Type::RValueReference: { 5509 QualType PointeeTy; 5510 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) { 5511 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>(); 5512 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) { 5513 S += ':'; 5514 return; 5515 } 5516 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType(); 5517 } else { 5518 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 5519 } 5520 5521 bool isReadOnly = false; 5522 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the 5523 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of 5524 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef! 5525 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type! 5526 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) { 5527 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) { 5528 isReadOnly = true; 5529 S += 'r'; 5530 } 5531 } else if (OutermostType) { 5532 QualType P = PointeeTy; 5533 while (P->getAs<PointerType>()) 5534 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5535 if (P.isConstQualified()) { 5536 isReadOnly = true; 5537 S += 'r'; 5538 } 5539 } 5540 if (isReadOnly) { 5541 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type 5542 // combinations need to be rearranged. 5543 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn" 5544 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr")) 5545 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn"); 5546 } 5547 5548 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) { 5549 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a 5550 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'. 5551 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) { 5552 S += '*'; 5553 return; 5554 } 5555 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 5556 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#". 5557 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) { 5558 S += '#'; 5559 return; 5560 } 5561 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@". 5562 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) { 5563 S += '@'; 5564 return; 5565 } 5566 // fall through... 5567 } 5568 S += '^'; 5569 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy); 5570 5571 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures, 5572 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false, 5573 NotEncodedT); 5574 return; 5575 } 5576 5577 case Type::ConstantArray: 5578 case Type::IncompleteArray: 5579 case Type::VariableArray: { 5580 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT); 5581 5582 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) { 5583 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element. 5584 S += '^'; 5585 5586 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S, 5587 false, ExpandStructures, FD); 5588 } else { 5589 S += '['; 5590 5591 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 5592 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue()); 5593 else { 5594 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements. 5595 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) && 5596 "Unknown array type!"); 5597 S += '0'; 5598 } 5599 5600 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S, 5601 false, ExpandStructures, FD, 5602 false, false, false, false, false, false, 5603 NotEncodedT); 5604 S += ']'; 5605 } 5606 return; 5607 } 5608 5609 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 5610 case Type::FunctionProto: 5611 S += '?'; 5612 return; 5613 5614 case Type::Record: { 5615 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl(); 5616 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{'; 5617 // Anonymous structures print as '?' 5618 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) { 5619 S += II->getName(); 5620 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec 5621 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) { 5622 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs(); 5623 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S); 5624 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS, 5625 TemplateArgs.data(), 5626 TemplateArgs.size(), 5627 (*this).getPrintingPolicy()); 5628 } 5629 } else { 5630 S += '?'; 5631 } 5632 if (ExpandStructures) { 5633 S += '='; 5634 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) { 5635 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT); 5636 } else { 5637 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) { 5638 if (FD) { 5639 S += '"'; 5640 S += Field->getNameAsString(); 5641 S += '"'; 5642 } 5643 5644 // Special case bit-fields. 5645 if (Field->isBitField()) { 5646 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, 5647 Field); 5648 } else { 5649 QualType qt = Field->getType(); 5650 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt); 5651 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, 5652 FD, /*OutermostType*/false, 5653 /*EncodingProperty*/false, 5654 /*StructField*/true, 5655 false, false, false, NotEncodedT); 5656 } 5657 } 5658 } 5659 } 5660 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}'; 5661 return; 5662 } 5663 5664 case Type::BlockPointer: { 5665 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>(); 5666 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?". 5667 if (EncodeBlockParameters) { 5668 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 5669 5670 S += '<'; 5671 // Block return type 5672 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl( 5673 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, 5674 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty, 5675 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false, 5676 NotEncodedT); 5677 // Block self 5678 S += "@?"; 5679 // Block parameters 5680 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) { 5681 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types()) 5682 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl( 5683 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD, 5684 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty, 5685 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, 5686 false, NotEncodedT); 5687 } 5688 S += '>'; 5689 } 5690 return; 5691 } 5692 5693 case Type::ObjCObject: { 5694 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class 5695 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT); 5696 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) { 5697 S += "{objc_object=}"; 5698 return; 5699 } 5700 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) { 5701 S += "{objc_class=}"; 5702 return; 5703 } 5704 } 5705 5706 case Type::ObjCInterface: { 5707 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level. 5708 // @encode(class_name) 5709 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface(); 5710 S += '{'; 5711 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 5712 S += '='; 5713 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars; 5714 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars); 5715 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) { 5716 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]); 5717 if (Field->isBitField()) 5718 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field); 5719 else 5720 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD, 5721 false, false, false, false, false, 5722 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef, 5723 NotEncodedT); 5724 } 5725 S += '}'; 5726 return; 5727 } 5728 5729 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: { 5730 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5731 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) { 5732 S += '@'; 5733 return; 5734 } 5735 5736 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) { 5737 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'. 5738 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime 5739 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct. 5740 S += '#'; 5741 return; 5742 } 5743 5744 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 5745 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S, 5746 ExpandPointedToStructures, 5747 ExpandStructures, FD); 5748 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) { 5749 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list 5750 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding. 5751 S += '"'; 5752 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) { 5753 S += '<'; 5754 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 5755 S += '>'; 5756 } 5757 S += '"'; 5758 } 5759 return; 5760 } 5761 5762 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType(); 5763 if (!EncodingProperty && 5764 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) && 5765 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) { 5766 // Another historical/compatibility reason. 5767 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as 5768 // {...}; 5769 S += '^'; 5770 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 5771 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases. 5772 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl(); 5773 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars; 5774 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars); 5775 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) { 5776 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) { 5777 S += '{'; 5778 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 5779 S += '}'; 5780 return; 5781 } 5782 } 5783 } 5784 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, 5785 false, ExpandPointedToStructures, 5786 nullptr, 5787 false, false, false, false, false, 5788 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true); 5789 return; 5790 } 5791 5792 S += '@'; 5793 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() && 5794 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) { 5795 S += '"'; 5796 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 5797 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) { 5798 S += '<'; 5799 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 5800 S += '>'; 5801 } 5802 S += '"'; 5803 } 5804 return; 5805 } 5806 5807 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers. 5808 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available. 5809 case Type::MemberPointer: 5810 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient. 5811 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc. 5812 case Type::Vector: 5813 case Type::ExtVector: 5814 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning. 5815 { if (NotEncodedT) 5816 *NotEncodedT = T; 5817 return; 5818 } 5819 5820 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery. 5821 // Just ignore it. 5822 case Type::Auto: 5823 return; 5824 5825 5826 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) 5827 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE) 5828 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \ 5829 case Type::KIND: 5830 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \ 5831 case Type::KIND: 5832 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \ 5833 case Type::KIND: 5834 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 5835 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!"); 5836 } 5837 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!"); 5838 } 5839 5840 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl, 5841 std::string &S, 5842 const FieldDecl *FD, 5843 bool includeVBases, 5844 QualType *NotEncodedT) const { 5845 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl"); 5846 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions"); 5847 if (!RDecl->getDefinition()) 5848 return; 5849 5850 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl); 5851 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets; 5852 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl); 5853 5854 if (CXXRec) { 5855 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) { 5856 if (!BI.isVirtual()) { 5857 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 5858 if (base->isEmpty()) 5859 continue; 5860 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base)); 5861 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs), 5862 std::make_pair(offs, base)); 5863 } 5864 } 5865 } 5866 5867 unsigned i = 0; 5868 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) { 5869 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i); 5870 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs), 5871 std::make_pair(offs, Field)); 5872 ++i; 5873 } 5874 5875 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) { 5876 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) { 5877 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 5878 if (base->isEmpty()) 5879 continue; 5880 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base)); 5881 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) && 5882 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end()) 5883 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(), 5884 std::make_pair(offs, base)); 5885 } 5886 } 5887 5888 CharUnits size; 5889 if (CXXRec) { 5890 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize(); 5891 } else { 5892 size = layout.getSize(); 5893 } 5894 5895 #ifndef NDEBUG 5896 uint64_t CurOffs = 0; 5897 #endif 5898 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator 5899 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin(); 5900 5901 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() && 5902 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) { 5903 if (FD) { 5904 S += "\"_vptr$"; 5905 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString(); 5906 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?"; 5907 S += recname; 5908 S += '"'; 5909 } 5910 S += "^^?"; 5911 #ifndef NDEBUG 5912 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy); 5913 #endif 5914 } 5915 5916 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 5917 // Mark the end of the structure. 5918 uint64_t offs = toBits(size); 5919 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs), 5920 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr)); 5921 } 5922 5923 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) { 5924 #ifndef NDEBUG 5925 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first); 5926 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) { 5927 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs; 5928 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that 5929 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case 5930 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout. 5931 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without 5932 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the 5933 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be 5934 // longer then though. 5935 CurOffs += padding; 5936 } 5937 #endif 5938 5939 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second; 5940 if (!dcl) 5941 break; // reached end of structure. 5942 5943 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) { 5944 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going 5945 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which 5946 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy, 5947 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is. 5948 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false, 5949 NotEncodedT); 5950 assert(!base->isEmpty()); 5951 #ifndef NDEBUG 5952 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize()); 5953 #endif 5954 } else { 5955 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl); 5956 if (FD) { 5957 S += '"'; 5958 S += field->getNameAsString(); 5959 S += '"'; 5960 } 5961 5962 if (field->isBitField()) { 5963 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field); 5964 #ifndef NDEBUG 5965 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this); 5966 #endif 5967 } else { 5968 QualType qt = field->getType(); 5969 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt); 5970 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD, 5971 /*OutermostType*/false, 5972 /*EncodingProperty*/false, 5973 /*StructField*/true, 5974 false, false, false, NotEncodedT); 5975 #ifndef NDEBUG 5976 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType()); 5977 #endif 5978 } 5979 } 5980 } 5981 } 5982 5983 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT, 5984 std::string& S) const { 5985 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In) 5986 S += 'n'; 5987 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout) 5988 S += 'N'; 5989 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out) 5990 S += 'o'; 5991 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy) 5992 S += 'O'; 5993 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref) 5994 S += 'R'; 5995 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway) 5996 S += 'V'; 5997 } 5998 5999 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const { 6000 if (!ObjCIdDecl) { 6001 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { }); 6002 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 6003 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id"); 6004 } 6005 return ObjCIdDecl; 6006 } 6007 6008 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const { 6009 if (!ObjCSelDecl) { 6010 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy); 6011 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL"); 6012 } 6013 return ObjCSelDecl; 6014 } 6015 6016 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const { 6017 if (!ObjCClassDecl) { 6018 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { }); 6019 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 6020 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class"); 6021 } 6022 return ObjCClassDecl; 6023 } 6024 6025 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const { 6026 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) { 6027 ObjCProtocolClassDecl 6028 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 6029 SourceLocation(), 6030 &Idents.get("Protocol"), 6031 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr, 6032 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 6033 SourceLocation(), true); 6034 } 6035 6036 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl; 6037 } 6038 6039 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6040 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions 6041 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6042 6043 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context, 6044 StringRef Name) { 6045 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list; 6046 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy); 6047 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name); 6048 } 6049 6050 static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6051 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list"); 6052 } 6053 6054 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6055 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list"); 6056 } 6057 6058 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6059 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list; 6060 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6061 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list"); 6062 } 6063 6064 static TypedefDecl * 6065 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6066 // struct __va_list 6067 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list"); 6068 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6069 // namespace std { struct __va_list { 6070 NamespaceDecl *NS; 6071 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 6072 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(), 6073 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(), 6074 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"), 6075 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr); 6076 NS->setImplicit(); 6077 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS); 6078 } 6079 6080 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 6081 6082 const size_t NumFields = 5; 6083 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 6084 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 6085 6086 // void *__stack; 6087 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6088 FieldNames[0] = "__stack"; 6089 6090 // void *__gr_top; 6091 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6092 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top"; 6093 6094 // void *__vr_top; 6095 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6096 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top"; 6097 6098 // int __gr_offs; 6099 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy; 6100 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs"; 6101 6102 // int __vr_offs; 6103 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy; 6104 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs"; 6105 6106 // Create fields 6107 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 6108 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 6109 VaListTagDecl, 6110 SourceLocation(), 6111 SourceLocation(), 6112 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 6113 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 6114 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 6115 /*Mutable=*/false, 6116 ICIS_NoInit); 6117 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 6118 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 6119 } 6120 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 6121 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 6122 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 6123 6124 // } __builtin_va_list; 6125 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list"); 6126 } 6127 6128 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6129 // typedef struct __va_list_tag { 6130 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl; 6131 6132 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag"); 6133 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 6134 6135 const size_t NumFields = 5; 6136 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 6137 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 6138 6139 // unsigned char gpr; 6140 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy; 6141 FieldNames[0] = "gpr"; 6142 6143 // unsigned char fpr; 6144 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy; 6145 FieldNames[1] = "fpr"; 6146 6147 // unsigned short reserved; 6148 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy; 6149 FieldNames[2] = "reserved"; 6150 6151 // void* overflow_arg_area; 6152 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6153 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area"; 6154 6155 // void* reg_save_area; 6156 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6157 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area"; 6158 6159 // Create fields 6160 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 6161 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl, 6162 SourceLocation(), 6163 SourceLocation(), 6164 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 6165 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 6166 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 6167 /*Mutable=*/false, 6168 ICIS_NoInit); 6169 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 6170 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 6171 } 6172 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 6173 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 6174 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 6175 6176 // } __va_list_tag; 6177 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl = 6178 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag"); 6179 6180 QualType VaListTagTypedefType = 6181 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl); 6182 6183 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1]; 6184 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1); 6185 QualType VaListTagArrayType 6186 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType, 6187 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6188 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 6189 } 6190 6191 static TypedefDecl * 6192 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6193 // struct __va_list_tag { 6194 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl; 6195 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag"); 6196 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 6197 6198 const size_t NumFields = 4; 6199 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 6200 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 6201 6202 // unsigned gp_offset; 6203 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy; 6204 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset"; 6205 6206 // unsigned fp_offset; 6207 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy; 6208 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset"; 6209 6210 // void* overflow_arg_area; 6211 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6212 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area"; 6213 6214 // void* reg_save_area; 6215 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6216 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area"; 6217 6218 // Create fields 6219 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 6220 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 6221 VaListTagDecl, 6222 SourceLocation(), 6223 SourceLocation(), 6224 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 6225 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 6226 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 6227 /*Mutable=*/false, 6228 ICIS_NoInit); 6229 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 6230 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 6231 } 6232 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 6233 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 6234 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 6235 6236 // }; 6237 6238 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1]; 6239 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1); 6240 QualType VaListTagArrayType = 6241 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6242 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 6243 } 6244 6245 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6246 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4]; 6247 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4); 6248 QualType IntArrayType 6249 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, 6250 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6251 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 6252 } 6253 6254 static TypedefDecl * 6255 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6256 // struct __va_list 6257 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list"); 6258 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6259 // namespace std { struct __va_list { 6260 NamespaceDecl *NS; 6261 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 6262 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(), 6263 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(), 6264 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"), 6265 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr); 6266 NS->setImplicit(); 6267 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS); 6268 } 6269 6270 VaListDecl->startDefinition(); 6271 6272 // void * __ap; 6273 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 6274 VaListDecl, 6275 SourceLocation(), 6276 SourceLocation(), 6277 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"), 6278 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy), 6279 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 6280 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 6281 /*Mutable=*/false, 6282 ICIS_NoInit); 6283 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 6284 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field); 6285 6286 // }; 6287 VaListDecl->completeDefinition(); 6288 6289 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list; 6290 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl); 6291 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list"); 6292 } 6293 6294 static TypedefDecl * 6295 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 6296 // struct __va_list_tag { 6297 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl; 6298 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag"); 6299 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 6300 6301 const size_t NumFields = 4; 6302 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 6303 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 6304 6305 // long __gpr; 6306 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy; 6307 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr"; 6308 6309 // long __fpr; 6310 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy; 6311 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr"; 6312 6313 // void *__overflow_arg_area; 6314 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6315 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area"; 6316 6317 // void *__reg_save_area; 6318 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 6319 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area"; 6320 6321 // Create fields 6322 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 6323 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 6324 VaListTagDecl, 6325 SourceLocation(), 6326 SourceLocation(), 6327 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 6328 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 6329 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 6330 /*Mutable=*/false, 6331 ICIS_NoInit); 6332 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 6333 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 6334 } 6335 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 6336 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 6337 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 6338 6339 // }; 6340 6341 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1]; 6342 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1); 6343 QualType VaListTagArrayType = 6344 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6345 6346 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 6347 } 6348 6349 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context, 6350 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) { 6351 switch (Kind) { 6352 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList: 6353 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6354 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList: 6355 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6356 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList: 6357 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6358 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList: 6359 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6360 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList: 6361 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6362 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList: 6363 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6364 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList: 6365 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6366 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList: 6367 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 6368 } 6369 6370 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind"); 6371 } 6372 6373 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const { 6374 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) { 6375 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind()); 6376 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit()); 6377 } 6378 6379 return BuiltinVaListDecl; 6380 } 6381 6382 Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const { 6383 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list 6384 // declaration. 6385 if (!VaListTagDecl) 6386 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl(); 6387 6388 return VaListTagDecl; 6389 } 6390 6391 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const { 6392 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl) 6393 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this); 6394 6395 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl; 6396 } 6397 6398 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) { 6399 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() && 6400 "'NSConstantString' type already set!"); 6401 6402 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl); 6403 } 6404 6405 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty 6406 /// lookup. 6407 TemplateName 6408 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin, 6409 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const { 6410 unsigned size = End - Begin; 6411 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!"); 6412 6413 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) + 6414 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*)); 6415 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size); 6416 6417 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage(); 6418 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) { 6419 NamedDecl *D = *I; 6420 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) || 6421 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) && 6422 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl()))); 6423 *Storage++ = D; 6424 } 6425 6426 return TemplateName(OT); 6427 } 6428 6429 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified 6430 /// template name such as \c std::vector. 6431 TemplateName 6432 ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 6433 bool TemplateKeyword, 6434 TemplateDecl *Template) const { 6435 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name"); 6436 6437 // FIXME: Canonicalization? 6438 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 6439 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template); 6440 6441 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 6442 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = 6443 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 6444 if (!QTN) { 6445 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>()) 6446 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template); 6447 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos); 6448 } 6449 6450 return TemplateName(QTN); 6451 } 6452 6453 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent 6454 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply. 6455 TemplateName 6456 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 6457 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const { 6458 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) && 6459 "Nested name specifier must be dependent"); 6460 6461 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 6462 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name); 6463 6464 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 6465 DependentTemplateName *QTN = 6466 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 6467 6468 if (QTN) 6469 return TemplateName(QTN); 6470 6471 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 6472 if (CanonNNS == NNS) { 6473 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>()) 6474 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name); 6475 } else { 6476 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name); 6477 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>()) 6478 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon); 6479 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN = 6480 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 6481 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken"); 6482 (void)CheckQTN; 6483 } 6484 6485 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos); 6486 return TemplateName(QTN); 6487 } 6488 6489 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent 6490 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+. 6491 TemplateName 6492 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 6493 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const { 6494 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) && 6495 "Nested name specifier must be dependent"); 6496 6497 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 6498 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator); 6499 6500 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 6501 DependentTemplateName *QTN 6502 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 6503 6504 if (QTN) 6505 return TemplateName(QTN); 6506 6507 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 6508 if (CanonNNS == NNS) { 6509 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>()) 6510 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator); 6511 } else { 6512 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator); 6513 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>()) 6514 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon); 6515 6516 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN 6517 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 6518 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken"); 6519 (void)CheckQTN; 6520 } 6521 6522 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos); 6523 return TemplateName(QTN); 6524 } 6525 6526 TemplateName 6527 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param, 6528 TemplateName replacement) const { 6529 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 6530 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement); 6531 6532 void *insertPos = nullptr; 6533 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst 6534 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 6535 6536 if (!subst) { 6537 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement); 6538 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos); 6539 } 6540 6541 return TemplateName(subst); 6542 } 6543 6544 TemplateName 6545 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param, 6546 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const { 6547 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this); 6548 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 6549 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack); 6550 6551 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 6552 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst 6553 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 6554 6555 if (!Subst) { 6556 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param, 6557 ArgPack.pack_size(), 6558 ArgPack.pack_begin()); 6559 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos); 6560 } 6561 6562 return TemplateName(Subst); 6563 } 6564 6565 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by 6566 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type 6567 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType. 6568 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const { 6569 switch (Type) { 6570 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType(); 6571 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy; 6572 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy; 6573 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy; 6574 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy; 6575 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy; 6576 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy; 6577 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy; 6578 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy; 6579 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy; 6580 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy; 6581 } 6582 6583 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value"); 6584 } 6585 6586 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6587 // Type Predicates. 6588 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6589 6590 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's 6591 /// garbage collection attribute. 6592 /// 6593 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const { 6594 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC) 6595 return Qualifiers::GCNone; 6596 6597 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1); 6598 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr(); 6599 6600 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers 6601 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared 6602 // as __strong. 6603 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) { 6604 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) 6605 return Qualifiers::Strong; 6606 else if (Ty->isPointerType()) 6607 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 6608 } else { 6609 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a 6610 // pointer. 6611 #ifndef NDEBUG 6612 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal(); 6613 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT)) 6614 CT = AT->getElementType(); 6615 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType()); 6616 #endif 6617 } 6618 return GCAttrs; 6619 } 6620 6621 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6622 // Type Compatibility Testing 6623 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6624 6625 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are 6626 /// compatible. 6627 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS, 6628 const VectorType *RHS) { 6629 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified()); 6630 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() && 6631 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements(); 6632 } 6633 6634 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec, 6635 QualType SecondVec) { 6636 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type"); 6637 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type"); 6638 6639 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec)) 6640 return true; 6641 6642 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the 6643 // equivalent GCC vector types. 6644 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>(); 6645 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>(); 6646 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() && 6647 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) && 6648 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel && 6649 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool && 6650 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel && 6651 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool) 6652 return true; 6653 6654 return false; 6655 } 6656 6657 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6658 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's. 6659 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6660 6661 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the 6662 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'. 6663 bool 6664 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto, 6665 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const { 6666 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto)) 6667 return true; 6668 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols()) 6669 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI)) 6670 return true; 6671 return false; 6672 } 6673 6674 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and 6675 /// Class<pr1, ...>. 6676 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, 6677 QualType rhs) { 6678 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6679 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6680 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible"); 6681 6682 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) { 6683 bool match = false; 6684 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) { 6685 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) { 6686 match = true; 6687 break; 6688 } 6689 } 6690 if (!match) 6691 return false; 6692 } 6693 return true; 6694 } 6695 6696 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an 6697 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType. 6698 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs, 6699 bool compare) { 6700 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases. 6701 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() || 6702 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType()) 6703 return true; 6704 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() || 6705 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType()) 6706 return true; 6707 6708 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 6709 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6710 6711 if (!rhsOPT) return false; 6712 6713 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) { 6714 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*", 6715 // make sure we check the class hierarchy. 6716 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 6717 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) { 6718 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs, 6719 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 6720 // through its super class and categories. 6721 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) 6722 return false; 6723 } 6724 } 6725 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'. 6726 return true; 6727 } 6728 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 6729 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) { 6730 bool match = false; 6731 6732 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs, 6733 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 6734 // through its super class and categories. 6735 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) { 6736 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) || 6737 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) { 6738 match = true; 6739 break; 6740 } 6741 } 6742 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*", 6743 // make sure we check the class hierarchy. 6744 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 6745 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) { 6746 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs, 6747 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 6748 // through its super class and categories. 6749 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) { 6750 match = true; 6751 break; 6752 } 6753 } 6754 } 6755 if (!match) 6756 return false; 6757 } 6758 6759 return true; 6760 } 6761 6762 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType(); 6763 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>"); 6764 6765 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = 6766 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) { 6767 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 6768 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) { 6769 bool match = false; 6770 6771 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs, 6772 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 6773 // through its super class and categories. 6774 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct 6775 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch. 6776 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) { 6777 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) || 6778 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) { 6779 match = true; 6780 break; 6781 } 6782 } 6783 if (!match) 6784 return false; 6785 } 6786 6787 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols 6788 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch. 6789 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 6790 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols; 6791 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols); 6792 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has 6793 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s) 6794 // assume that it is mismatch. 6795 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty()) 6796 return false; 6797 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) { 6798 bool match = false; 6799 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) { 6800 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) || 6801 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) { 6802 match = true; 6803 break; 6804 } 6805 } 6806 if (!match) 6807 return false; 6808 } 6809 } 6810 return true; 6811 } 6812 return false; 6813 } 6814 6815 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are 6816 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any 6817 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS. 6818 /// 6819 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT, 6820 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) { 6821 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType(); 6822 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType(); 6823 6824 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true. 6825 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() || 6826 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass()) 6827 return true; 6828 6829 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles 6830 // __kindof types. 6831 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool { 6832 if (succeeded) 6833 return true; 6834 6835 if (!RHS->isKindOfType()) 6836 return false; 6837 6838 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether 6839 // we can assign the other way. 6840 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this), 6841 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this)); 6842 }; 6843 6844 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) { 6845 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0), 6846 QualType(RHSOPT,0), 6847 false)); 6848 } 6849 6850 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) { 6851 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0), 6852 QualType(RHSOPT,0))); 6853 } 6854 6855 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path. 6856 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) { 6857 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)); 6858 } 6859 6860 return false; 6861 } 6862 6863 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written 6864 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return 6865 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where 6866 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is 6867 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK. 6868 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer( 6869 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT, 6870 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT, 6871 bool BlockReturnType) { 6872 6873 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles 6874 // __kindof types. 6875 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool { 6876 if (succeeded) 6877 return true; 6878 6879 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT; 6880 if (!Expected->isKindOfType()) 6881 return false; 6882 6883 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether 6884 // we can assign the other way. 6885 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer( 6886 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this), 6887 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this), 6888 BlockReturnType); 6889 }; 6890 6891 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType()) 6892 return true; 6893 6894 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6895 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || 6896 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()); 6897 } 6898 6899 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6900 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0), 6901 QualType(RHSOPT,0), 6902 false)); 6903 6904 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType(); 6905 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType(); 6906 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types. 6907 if (LHS != RHS) { 6908 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl())) 6909 return finish(BlockReturnType); 6910 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl())) 6911 return finish(!BlockReturnType); 6912 } 6913 else 6914 return true; 6915 } 6916 return false; 6917 } 6918 6919 /// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with 6920 /// llvm::array_pod_sort. 6921 static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs, 6922 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) { 6923 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName()); 6924 6925 } 6926 6927 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set 6928 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with 6929 /// the given common base. 6930 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of 6931 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects. 6932 static 6933 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context, 6934 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase, 6935 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT, 6936 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT, 6937 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) { 6938 6939 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType(); 6940 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType(); 6941 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base"); 6942 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base"); 6943 6944 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS. 6945 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet; 6946 6947 // Start with the protocol qualifiers. 6948 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) { 6949 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet); 6950 } 6951 6952 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface. 6953 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet); 6954 6955 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS. 6956 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet; 6957 6958 // Start with the protocol qualifiers. 6959 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) { 6960 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet); 6961 } 6962 6963 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface. 6964 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet); 6965 6966 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets. 6967 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) { 6968 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto)) 6969 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto); 6970 } 6971 6972 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or 6973 // the protocols within the intersection. 6974 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols; 6975 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols); 6976 6977 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols. 6978 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) { 6979 IntersectionSet.erase( 6980 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(), 6981 IntersectionSet.end(), 6982 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool { 6983 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0; 6984 }), 6985 IntersectionSet.end()); 6986 } 6987 6988 // Sort the remaining protocols by name. 6989 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(), 6990 compareObjCProtocolsByName); 6991 } 6992 6993 /// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second. 6994 static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs, 6995 QualType rhs) { 6996 // Common case: two object pointers. 6997 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6998 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6999 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT) 7000 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT); 7001 7002 // Two block pointers. 7003 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>(); 7004 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>(); 7005 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock) 7006 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs); 7007 7008 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's 7009 // acceptable. 7010 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) || 7011 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock)) 7012 return true; 7013 7014 return false; 7015 } 7016 7017 // Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent. 7018 static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx, 7019 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface, 7020 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs, 7021 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs, 7022 bool stripKindOf) { 7023 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size()) 7024 return false; 7025 7026 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList(); 7027 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) { 7028 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i])) 7029 continue; 7030 7031 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) { 7032 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant: 7033 if (!stripKindOf || 7034 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx), 7035 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) { 7036 return false; 7037 } 7038 break; 7039 7040 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant: 7041 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i])) 7042 return false; 7043 break; 7044 7045 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant: 7046 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i])) 7047 return false; 7048 break; 7049 } 7050 } 7051 7052 return true; 7053 } 7054 7055 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible( 7056 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr, 7057 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) { 7058 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType(); 7059 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType(); 7060 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface(); 7061 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface(); 7062 7063 if (!LDecl || !RDecl) 7064 return QualType(); 7065 7066 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a 7067 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it. 7068 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4> 7069 LHSAncestors; 7070 while (true) { 7071 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the 7072 // path from the LHS to the root. 7073 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS; 7074 7075 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) { 7076 // Get the type arguments. 7077 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten(); 7078 bool anyChanges = false; 7079 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) { 7080 // Both have type arguments, compare them. 7081 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(), 7082 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(), 7083 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) 7084 return QualType(); 7085 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) { 7086 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type 7087 // arguments. 7088 LHSTypeArgs = { }; 7089 anyChanges = true; 7090 } 7091 7092 // Compute the intersection of protocols. 7093 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols; 7094 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr, 7095 Protocols); 7096 if (!Protocols.empty()) 7097 anyChanges = true; 7098 7099 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type. 7100 if (anyChanges) { 7101 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface()); 7102 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols, 7103 LHS->isKindOfType()); 7104 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result); 7105 } 7106 7107 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0)); 7108 } 7109 7110 // Find the superclass. 7111 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType(); 7112 if (LHSSuperType.isNull()) 7113 break; 7114 7115 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 7116 } 7117 7118 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check 7119 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors. 7120 while (true) { 7121 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()); 7122 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) { 7123 LHS = KnownLHS->second; 7124 7125 // Get the type arguments. 7126 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten(); 7127 bool anyChanges = false; 7128 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) { 7129 // Both have type arguments, compare them. 7130 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(), 7131 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(), 7132 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) 7133 return QualType(); 7134 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) { 7135 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type 7136 // arguments. 7137 RHSTypeArgs = { }; 7138 anyChanges = true; 7139 } 7140 7141 // Compute the intersection of protocols. 7142 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols; 7143 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr, 7144 Protocols); 7145 if (!Protocols.empty()) 7146 anyChanges = true; 7147 7148 if (anyChanges) { 7149 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface()); 7150 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols, 7151 RHS->isKindOfType()); 7152 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result); 7153 } 7154 7155 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0)); 7156 } 7157 7158 // Find the superclass of the RHS. 7159 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType(); 7160 if (RHSSuperType.isNull()) 7161 break; 7162 7163 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 7164 } 7165 7166 return QualType(); 7167 } 7168 7169 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS, 7170 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) { 7171 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type"); 7172 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type"); 7173 7174 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of 7175 // the LHS. 7176 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface(); 7177 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()); 7178 if (!IsSuperClass) 7179 return false; 7180 7181 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are 7182 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the 7183 // LHS). 7184 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) { 7185 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types 7186 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols 7187 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok. 7188 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>. 7189 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols; 7190 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols); 7191 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's 7192 // qualifiers. 7193 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals()) 7194 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols); 7195 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match. 7196 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty()) 7197 return false; 7198 7199 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) { 7200 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false; 7201 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols) 7202 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) { 7203 SuperImplementsProtocol = true; 7204 break; 7205 } 7206 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol) 7207 return false; 7208 } 7209 } 7210 7211 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments. 7212 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) { 7213 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the 7214 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through. 7215 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS; 7216 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface)) 7217 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 7218 7219 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments. 7220 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() && 7221 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(), 7222 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(), 7223 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) { 7224 return false; 7225 } 7226 } 7227 7228 return true; 7229 } 7230 7231 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 7232 // get the "pointed to" types 7233 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7234 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7235 7236 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT) 7237 return false; 7238 7239 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) || 7240 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT); 7241 } 7242 7243 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) { 7244 return canAssignObjCInterfaces( 7245 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 7246 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()); 7247 } 7248 7249 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible, 7250 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type. 7251 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the 7252 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules. 7253 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS, 7254 bool CompareUnqualified) { 7255 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7256 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS); 7257 7258 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull(); 7259 } 7260 7261 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 7262 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS); 7263 } 7264 7265 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 7266 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull(); 7267 } 7268 7269 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member 7270 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return 7271 /// QualType() 7272 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType, 7273 bool OfBlockPointer, 7274 bool Unqualified) { 7275 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) { 7276 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 7277 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) { 7278 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) { 7279 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7280 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 7281 if (!MT.isNull()) 7282 return MT; 7283 } 7284 } 7285 } 7286 7287 return QualType(); 7288 } 7289 7290 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function 7291 /// parameter types 7292 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs, 7293 bool OfBlockPointer, 7294 bool Unqualified) { 7295 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function 7296 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other 7297 // type is compatible with a union member 7298 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, 7299 Unqualified); 7300 if (!lmerge.isNull()) 7301 return lmerge; 7302 7303 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer, 7304 Unqualified); 7305 if (!rmerge.isNull()) 7306 return rmerge; 7307 7308 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 7309 } 7310 7311 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs, 7312 bool OfBlockPointer, 7313 bool Unqualified) { 7314 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>(); 7315 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>(); 7316 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase); 7317 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase); 7318 bool allLTypes = true; 7319 bool allRTypes = true; 7320 7321 // Check return type 7322 QualType retType; 7323 if (OfBlockPointer) { 7324 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType(); 7325 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType(); 7326 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified; 7327 if (!UnqualifiedResult) 7328 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()); 7329 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true); 7330 } 7331 else 7332 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false, 7333 Unqualified); 7334 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType(); 7335 7336 if (Unqualified) 7337 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType(); 7338 7339 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType()); 7340 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType()); 7341 if (Unqualified) { 7342 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType(); 7343 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType(); 7344 } 7345 7346 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType) 7347 allLTypes = false; 7348 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType) 7349 allRTypes = false; 7350 7351 // FIXME: double check this 7352 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 && 7353 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 && 7354 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()? 7355 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo(); 7356 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo(); 7357 7358 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions 7359 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC()) 7360 return QualType(); 7361 7362 // Regparm is part of the calling convention. 7363 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm()) 7364 return QualType(); 7365 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm()) 7366 return QualType(); 7367 7368 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult()) 7369 return QualType(); 7370 7371 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'. 7372 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn(); 7373 7374 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn) 7375 allLTypes = false; 7376 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn) 7377 allRTypes = false; 7378 7379 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn); 7380 7381 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes 7382 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() && 7383 "C++ shouldn't be here"); 7384 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters 7385 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams()) 7386 return QualType(); 7387 7388 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible 7389 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic()) 7390 return QualType(); 7391 7392 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals()) 7393 return QualType(); 7394 7395 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount && 7396 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto)) 7397 return QualType(); 7398 7399 // Check parameter type compatibility 7400 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types; 7401 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) { 7402 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType(); 7403 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType(); 7404 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes( 7405 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 7406 if (paramType.isNull()) 7407 return QualType(); 7408 7409 if (Unqualified) 7410 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType(); 7411 7412 types.push_back(paramType); 7413 if (Unqualified) { 7414 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType(); 7415 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType(); 7416 } 7417 7418 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType)) 7419 allLTypes = false; 7420 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType)) 7421 allRTypes = false; 7422 } 7423 7424 if (allLTypes) return lhs; 7425 if (allRTypes) return rhs; 7426 7427 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo(); 7428 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo; 7429 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI); 7430 } 7431 7432 if (lproto) allRTypes = false; 7433 if (rproto) allLTypes = false; 7434 7435 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto; 7436 if (proto) { 7437 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here"); 7438 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType(); 7439 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that 7440 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15). 7441 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer 7442 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different 7443 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible. 7444 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) { 7445 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i); 7446 7447 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used 7448 // to pass enum values. 7449 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) { 7450 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7451 if (paramTy.isNull()) 7452 return QualType(); 7453 } 7454 7455 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() || 7456 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy) 7457 return QualType(); 7458 } 7459 7460 if (allLTypes) return lhs; 7461 if (allRTypes) return rhs; 7462 7463 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo(); 7464 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo; 7465 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI); 7466 } 7467 7468 if (allLTypes) return lhs; 7469 if (allRTypes) return rhs; 7470 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo); 7471 } 7472 7473 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them. 7474 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET, 7475 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) { 7476 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char, 7477 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type. 7478 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion 7479 // type. 7480 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7481 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType(); 7482 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other)) 7483 return other; 7484 7485 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any 7486 // integral type of the same size. 7487 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() && 7488 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other)) 7489 return other; 7490 7491 return QualType(); 7492 } 7493 7494 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS, 7495 bool OfBlockPointer, 7496 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) { 7497 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the 7498 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression 7499 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the 7500 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and 7501 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses). 7502 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?"); 7503 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?"); 7504 7505 if (Unqualified) { 7506 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 7507 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 7508 } 7509 7510 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS), 7511 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS); 7512 7513 // If two types are identical, they are compatible. 7514 if (LHSCan == RHSCan) 7515 return LHS; 7516 7517 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly. 7518 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 7519 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 7520 if (LQuals != RQuals) { 7521 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type 7522 // mismatch. 7523 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() || 7524 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() || 7525 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime()) 7526 return QualType(); 7527 7528 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is 7529 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective 7530 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix 7531 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually 7532 // qualified __strong. 7533 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 7534 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 7535 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements"); 7536 7537 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak) 7538 return QualType(); 7539 7540 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7541 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong)); 7542 } 7543 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7544 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS); 7545 } 7546 return QualType(); 7547 } 7548 7549 // Okay, qualifiers are equal. 7550 7551 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass(); 7552 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass(); 7553 7554 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these 7555 // comparisons, just force one to the other. 7556 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto; 7557 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto; 7558 7559 // Same as above for arrays 7560 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray) 7561 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray; 7562 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray) 7563 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray; 7564 7565 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects. 7566 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject; 7567 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject; 7568 7569 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector. 7570 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector; 7571 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector; 7572 7573 // If the canonical type classes don't match. 7574 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) { 7575 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum 7576 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa. 7577 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) { 7578 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false); 7579 } 7580 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) { 7581 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType); 7582 } 7583 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type. 7584 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) { 7585 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType()) 7586 return LHS; 7587 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType()) 7588 return RHS; 7589 } 7590 7591 return QualType(); 7592 } 7593 7594 // The canonical type classes match. 7595 switch (LHSClass) { 7596 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 7597 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 7598 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 7599 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 7600 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 7601 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 7602 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here"); 7603 7604 case Type::Auto: 7605 case Type::LValueReference: 7606 case Type::RValueReference: 7607 case Type::MemberPointer: 7608 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes"); 7609 7610 case Type::ObjCInterface: 7611 case Type::IncompleteArray: 7612 case Type::VariableArray: 7613 case Type::FunctionProto: 7614 case Type::ExtVector: 7615 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above"); 7616 7617 case Type::Pointer: 7618 { 7619 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info 7620 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7621 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7622 if (Unqualified) { 7623 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 7624 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 7625 } 7626 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false, 7627 Unqualified); 7628 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType(); 7629 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7630 return LHS; 7631 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7632 return RHS; 7633 return getPointerType(ResultType); 7634 } 7635 case Type::BlockPointer: 7636 { 7637 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info 7638 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7639 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7640 if (Unqualified) { 7641 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 7642 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 7643 } 7644 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer, 7645 Unqualified); 7646 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType(); 7647 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7648 return LHS; 7649 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7650 return RHS; 7651 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType); 7652 } 7653 case Type::Atomic: 7654 { 7655 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info 7656 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType(); 7657 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType(); 7658 if (Unqualified) { 7659 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType(); 7660 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType(); 7661 } 7662 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false, 7663 Unqualified); 7664 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType(); 7665 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7666 return LHS; 7667 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7668 return RHS; 7669 return getAtomicType(ResultType); 7670 } 7671 case Type::ConstantArray: 7672 { 7673 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS); 7674 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS); 7675 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize()) 7676 return QualType(); 7677 7678 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType(); 7679 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType(); 7680 if (Unqualified) { 7681 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType(); 7682 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType(); 7683 } 7684 7685 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified); 7686 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType(); 7687 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7688 return LHS; 7689 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7690 return RHS; 7691 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(), 7692 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0); 7693 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(), 7694 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0); 7695 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS); 7696 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS); 7697 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7698 return LHS; 7699 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 7700 return RHS; 7701 if (LVAT) { 7702 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because 7703 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type 7704 // has to be different. 7705 return LHS; 7706 } 7707 if (RVAT) { 7708 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because 7709 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type 7710 // has to be different. 7711 return RHS; 7712 } 7713 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS; 7714 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS; 7715 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType, 7716 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0); 7717 } 7718 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 7719 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 7720 case Type::Record: 7721 case Type::Enum: 7722 return QualType(); 7723 case Type::Builtin: 7724 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above. 7725 return QualType(); 7726 case Type::Complex: 7727 // Distinct complex types are incompatible. 7728 return QualType(); 7729 case Type::Vector: 7730 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector! 7731 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(), 7732 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>())) 7733 return LHS; 7734 return QualType(); 7735 case Type::ObjCObject: { 7736 // Check if the types are assignment compatible. 7737 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether 7738 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal. 7739 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 7740 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 7741 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface)) 7742 return LHS; 7743 7744 return QualType(); 7745 } 7746 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: { 7747 if (OfBlockPointer) { 7748 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer( 7749 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 7750 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 7751 BlockReturnType)) 7752 return LHS; 7753 return QualType(); 7754 } 7755 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 7756 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())) 7757 return LHS; 7758 7759 return QualType(); 7760 } 7761 } 7762 7763 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!"); 7764 } 7765 7766 bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs( 7767 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType, 7768 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) { 7769 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() != 7770 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams()) 7771 return false; 7772 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI = 7773 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo(); 7774 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI = 7775 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo(); 7776 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters) 7777 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) { 7778 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i]) 7779 return false; 7780 } 7781 return true; 7782 } 7783 7784 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and 7785 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function 7786 /// return types. 7787 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 7788 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS), 7789 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS); 7790 // If two types are identical, they are compatible. 7791 if (LHSCan == RHSCan) 7792 return LHS; 7793 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) { 7794 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType()) 7795 return QualType(); 7796 QualType OldReturnType = 7797 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType(); 7798 QualType NewReturnType = 7799 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType(); 7800 QualType ResReturnType = 7801 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType); 7802 if (ResReturnType.isNull()) 7803 return QualType(); 7804 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) { 7805 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo(); 7806 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type. 7807 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>(); 7808 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) { 7809 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 7810 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS); 7811 QualType ResultType = 7812 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 7813 return ResultType; 7814 } 7815 } 7816 return QualType(); 7817 } 7818 7819 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged. 7820 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 7821 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 7822 if (LQuals != RQuals) { 7823 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch. 7824 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() || 7825 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace()) 7826 return QualType(); 7827 7828 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is 7829 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective 7830 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix 7831 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually 7832 // qualified __strong. 7833 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 7834 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 7835 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements"); 7836 7837 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak) 7838 return QualType(); 7839 7840 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong) 7841 return LHS; 7842 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong) 7843 return RHS; 7844 return QualType(); 7845 } 7846 7847 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7848 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7849 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7850 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT); 7851 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT) 7852 return LHS; 7853 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT) 7854 return RHS; 7855 } 7856 return QualType(); 7857 } 7858 7859 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7860 // Integer Predicates 7861 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7862 7863 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const { 7864 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 7865 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7866 if (T->isBooleanType()) 7867 return 1; 7868 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method 7869 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T); 7870 } 7871 7872 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const { 7873 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type"); 7874 7875 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int> 7876 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>()) 7877 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()), 7878 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind()); 7879 7880 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type. 7881 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 7882 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7883 7884 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 7885 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type"); 7886 switch (BTy->getKind()) { 7887 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 7888 case BuiltinType::SChar: 7889 return UnsignedCharTy; 7890 case BuiltinType::Short: 7891 return UnsignedShortTy; 7892 case BuiltinType::Int: 7893 return UnsignedIntTy; 7894 case BuiltinType::Long: 7895 return UnsignedLongTy; 7896 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 7897 return UnsignedLongLongTy; 7898 case BuiltinType::Int128: 7899 return UnsignedInt128Ty; 7900 default: 7901 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type"); 7902 } 7903 } 7904 7905 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { } 7906 7907 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD, 7908 QualType ReturnType) {} 7909 7910 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7911 // Builtin Type Computation 7912 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7913 7914 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the 7915 /// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If 7916 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic 7917 /// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of 7918 /// a vector of "i*". 7919 /// 7920 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required 7921 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression. 7922 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context, 7923 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error, 7924 bool &RequiresICE, 7925 bool AllowTypeModifiers) { 7926 // Modifiers. 7927 int HowLong = 0; 7928 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false; 7929 RequiresICE = false; 7930 7931 // Read the prefixed modifiers first. 7932 bool Done = false; 7933 while (!Done) { 7934 switch (*Str++) { 7935 default: Done = true; --Str; break; 7936 case 'I': 7937 RequiresICE = true; 7938 break; 7939 case 'S': 7940 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!"); 7941 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!"); 7942 Signed = true; 7943 break; 7944 case 'U': 7945 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!"); 7946 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!"); 7947 Unsigned = true; 7948 break; 7949 case 'L': 7950 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier"); 7951 ++HowLong; 7952 break; 7953 case 'W': 7954 // This modifier represents int64 type. 7955 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!"); 7956 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) { 7957 default: 7958 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type"); 7959 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: 7960 HowLong = 1; 7961 break; 7962 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: 7963 HowLong = 2; 7964 break; 7965 } 7966 } 7967 } 7968 7969 QualType Type; 7970 7971 // Read the base type. 7972 switch (*Str++) { 7973 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!"); 7974 case 'v': 7975 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 7976 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!"); 7977 Type = Context.VoidTy; 7978 break; 7979 case 'h': 7980 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 7981 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!"); 7982 Type = Context.HalfTy; 7983 break; 7984 case 'f': 7985 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 7986 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!"); 7987 Type = Context.FloatTy; 7988 break; 7989 case 'd': 7990 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 7991 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!"); 7992 if (HowLong) 7993 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy; 7994 else 7995 Type = Context.DoubleTy; 7996 break; 7997 case 's': 7998 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!"); 7999 if (Unsigned) 8000 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 8001 else 8002 Type = Context.ShortTy; 8003 break; 8004 case 'i': 8005 if (HowLong == 3) 8006 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty; 8007 else if (HowLong == 2) 8008 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 8009 else if (HowLong == 1) 8010 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 8011 else 8012 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 8013 break; 8014 case 'c': 8015 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!"); 8016 if (Signed) 8017 Type = Context.SignedCharTy; 8018 else if (Unsigned) 8019 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 8020 else 8021 Type = Context.CharTy; 8022 break; 8023 case 'b': // boolean 8024 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!"); 8025 Type = Context.BoolTy; 8026 break; 8027 case 'z': // size_t. 8028 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!"); 8029 Type = Context.getSizeType(); 8030 break; 8031 case 'F': 8032 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType(); 8033 break; 8034 case 'G': 8035 Type = Context.getObjCIdType(); 8036 break; 8037 case 'H': 8038 Type = Context.getObjCSelType(); 8039 break; 8040 case 'M': 8041 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType(); 8042 break; 8043 case 'a': 8044 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 8045 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!"); 8046 break; 8047 case 'A': 8048 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly 8049 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two 8050 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones 8051 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is 8052 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list 8053 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86, 8054 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want 8055 // it to be a __va_list_tag*. 8056 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 8057 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!"); 8058 if (Type->isArrayType()) 8059 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type); 8060 else 8061 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type); 8062 break; 8063 case 'V': { 8064 char *End; 8065 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10); 8066 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size"); 8067 Str = End; 8068 8069 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, 8070 RequiresICE, false); 8071 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE"); 8072 8073 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet. 8074 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements, 8075 VectorType::GenericVector); 8076 break; 8077 } 8078 case 'E': { 8079 char *End; 8080 8081 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10); 8082 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size"); 8083 8084 Str = End; 8085 8086 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE, 8087 false); 8088 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements); 8089 break; 8090 } 8091 case 'X': { 8092 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE, 8093 false); 8094 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE"); 8095 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType); 8096 break; 8097 } 8098 case 'Y' : { 8099 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType(); 8100 break; 8101 } 8102 case 'P': 8103 Type = Context.getFILEType(); 8104 if (Type.isNull()) { 8105 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio; 8106 return QualType(); 8107 } 8108 break; 8109 case 'J': 8110 if (Signed) 8111 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType(); 8112 else 8113 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType(); 8114 8115 if (Type.isNull()) { 8116 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp; 8117 return QualType(); 8118 } 8119 break; 8120 case 'K': 8121 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!"); 8122 Type = Context.getucontext_tType(); 8123 8124 if (Type.isNull()) { 8125 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext; 8126 return QualType(); 8127 } 8128 break; 8129 case 'p': 8130 Type = Context.getProcessIDType(); 8131 break; 8132 } 8133 8134 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it. 8135 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers; 8136 while (!Done) { 8137 switch (char c = *Str++) { 8138 default: Done = true; --Str; break; 8139 case '*': 8140 case '&': { 8141 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types 8142 // qualified with an address space. 8143 char *End; 8144 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10); 8145 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) { 8146 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace); 8147 Str = End; 8148 } 8149 if (c == '*') 8150 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type); 8151 else 8152 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type); 8153 break; 8154 } 8155 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg. 8156 case 'C': 8157 Type = Type.withConst(); 8158 break; 8159 case 'D': 8160 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type); 8161 break; 8162 case 'R': 8163 Type = Type.withRestrict(); 8164 break; 8165 } 8166 } 8167 8168 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) && 8169 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer"); 8170 8171 return Type; 8172 } 8173 8174 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin. 8175 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id, 8176 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error, 8177 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const { 8178 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id); 8179 8180 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 8181 8182 bool RequiresICE = false; 8183 Error = GE_None; 8184 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, 8185 RequiresICE, true); 8186 if (Error != GE_None) 8187 return QualType(); 8188 8189 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE"); 8190 8191 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') { 8192 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true); 8193 if (Error != GE_None) 8194 return QualType(); 8195 8196 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the 8197 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return. 8198 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs) 8199 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size(); 8200 8201 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type. 8202 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 8203 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 8204 8205 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty); 8206 } 8207 8208 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo) 8209 return QualType(); 8210 8211 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) && 8212 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!"); 8213 8214 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C); 8215 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true); 8216 8217 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.'); 8218 8219 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++. 8220 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic) 8221 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI); 8222 8223 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 8224 EPI.ExtInfo = EI; 8225 EPI.Variadic = Variadic; 8226 8227 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI); 8228 } 8229 8230 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context, 8231 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 8232 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 8233 return GVA_Internal; 8234 8235 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal; 8236 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) { 8237 case TSK_Undeclared: 8238 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization: 8239 External = GVA_StrongExternal; 8240 break; 8241 8242 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition: 8243 return GVA_StrongODR; 8244 8245 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10: 8246 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of 8247 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly 8248 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for 8249 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be 8250 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ] 8251 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration: 8252 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 8253 8254 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation: 8255 External = GVA_DiscardableODR; 8256 break; 8257 } 8258 8259 if (!FD->isInlined()) 8260 return External; 8261 8262 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 8263 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) || 8264 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 8265 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions. 8266 8267 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be 8268 // externally visible. 8269 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible()) 8270 return External; 8271 8272 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible. 8273 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 8274 } 8275 8276 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode 8277 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later 8278 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded. 8279 if (FD->isMSExternInline()) 8280 return GVA_StrongODR; 8281 8282 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 8283 } 8284 8285 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) { 8286 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx 8287 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions. 8288 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) { 8289 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR) 8290 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 8291 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 8292 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR) 8293 return GVA_StrongODR; 8294 } 8295 return L; 8296 } 8297 8298 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const { 8299 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD), 8300 FD); 8301 } 8302 8303 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context, 8304 const VarDecl *VD) { 8305 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible()) 8306 return GVA_Internal; 8307 8308 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) { 8309 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR; 8310 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod(); 8311 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext)) 8312 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent(); 8313 8314 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest 8315 // enclosing function. 8316 if (LexicalContext) 8317 StaticLocalLinkage = 8318 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext)); 8319 8320 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need, 8321 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR. 8322 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it. 8323 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR 8324 : StaticLocalLinkage; 8325 } 8326 8327 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions. 8328 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't 8329 // cause link errors. 8330 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD)) 8331 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 8332 8333 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) { 8334 case TSK_Undeclared: 8335 return GVA_StrongExternal; 8336 8337 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization: 8338 return Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() 8339 ? GVA_StrongODR 8340 : GVA_StrongExternal; 8341 8342 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition: 8343 return GVA_StrongODR; 8344 8345 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration: 8346 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 8347 8348 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation: 8349 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 8350 } 8351 8352 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!"); 8353 } 8354 8355 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) { 8356 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD), 8357 VD); 8358 } 8359 8360 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) { 8361 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 8362 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl()) 8363 return false; 8364 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted. 8365 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register) 8366 return false; 8367 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 8368 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 8369 return false; 8370 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 8371 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template. 8372 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 8373 return false; 8374 } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D)) 8375 return true; 8376 else 8377 return false; 8378 8379 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it. 8380 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 8381 return false; 8382 8383 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves. 8384 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) 8385 return false; 8386 8387 // Aliases and used decls are required. 8388 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 8389 return true; 8390 8391 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 8392 // Forward declarations aren't required. 8393 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 8394 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition(); 8395 8396 // Constructors and destructors are required. 8397 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) 8398 return true; 8399 8400 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes 8401 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though. 8402 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 8403 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8404 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent(); 8405 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) { 8406 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD); 8407 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl()) 8408 return true; 8409 } 8410 } 8411 } 8412 8413 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD); 8414 8415 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can 8416 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++. 8417 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++. 8418 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally || 8419 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR) 8420 return false; 8421 return true; 8422 } 8423 8424 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D); 8425 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var"); 8426 8427 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 8428 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD)) 8429 return false; 8430 8431 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required. 8432 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD); 8433 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally && 8434 L != GVA_DiscardableODR) 8435 return true; 8436 8437 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required. 8438 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType()) 8439 return true; 8440 8441 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required. 8442 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) && 8443 !VD->evaluateValue()) 8444 return true; 8445 8446 return false; 8447 } 8448 8449 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic, 8450 bool IsCXXMethod) const { 8451 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object 8452 if (IsCXXMethod) 8453 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic); 8454 8455 if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall; 8456 8457 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown); 8458 } 8459 8460 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const { 8461 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object 8462 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD); 8463 } 8464 8465 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() { 8466 if (!VTContext.get()) { 8467 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 8468 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this)); 8469 else 8470 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this)); 8471 } 8472 return VTContext.get(); 8473 } 8474 8475 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() { 8476 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) { 8477 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: 8478 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium: 8479 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: 8480 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS: 8481 case TargetCXXABI::iOS: 8482 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64: 8483 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly: 8484 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics()); 8485 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft: 8486 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics()); 8487 } 8488 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI"); 8489 } 8490 8491 CXXABI::~CXXABI() {} 8492 8493 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const { 8494 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() + 8495 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) + 8496 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) + 8497 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) + 8498 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) + 8499 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) + 8500 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) + 8501 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) + 8502 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) + 8503 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) + 8504 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) + 8505 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) + 8506 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) + 8507 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern); 8508 } 8509 8510 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth - 8511 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details: 8512 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned. 8513 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types. 8514 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth, 8515 unsigned Signed) const { 8516 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed); 8517 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty); 8518 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128) 8519 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty; 8520 return QualTy; 8521 } 8522 8523 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth - 8524 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth. 8525 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types. 8526 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const { 8527 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth); 8528 switch (Ty) { 8529 case TargetInfo::Float: 8530 return FloatTy; 8531 case TargetInfo::Double: 8532 return DoubleTy; 8533 case TargetInfo::LongDouble: 8534 return LongDoubleTy; 8535 case TargetInfo::NoFloat: 8536 return QualType(); 8537 } 8538 8539 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value"); 8540 } 8541 8542 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) { 8543 if (Number > 1) 8544 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number; 8545 } 8546 8547 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const { 8548 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I = 8549 MangleNumbers.find(ND); 8550 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1; 8551 } 8552 8553 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) { 8554 if (Number > 1) 8555 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number; 8556 } 8557 8558 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const { 8559 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I = 8560 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD); 8561 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1; 8562 } 8563 8564 MangleNumberingContext & 8565 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) { 8566 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C. 8567 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC]; 8568 if (!MCtx) 8569 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext(); 8570 return *MCtx; 8571 } 8572 8573 MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const { 8574 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext(); 8575 } 8576 8577 const CXXConstructorDecl * 8578 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 8579 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject( 8580 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl())); 8581 } 8582 8583 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD, 8584 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) { 8585 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject( 8586 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()), 8587 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl())); 8588 } 8589 8590 void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD, 8591 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) { 8592 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor( 8593 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE); 8594 } 8595 8596 Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD, 8597 unsigned ParmIdx) { 8598 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor( 8599 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx); 8600 } 8601 8602 void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD, 8603 TypedefNameDecl *DD) { 8604 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD); 8605 } 8606 8607 TypedefNameDecl * 8608 ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) { 8609 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD); 8610 } 8611 8612 void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD, 8613 DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 8614 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD); 8615 } 8616 8617 DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) { 8618 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD); 8619 } 8620 8621 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) { 8622 ParamIndices[D] = index; 8623 } 8624 8625 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const { 8626 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D); 8627 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() && 8628 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl"); 8629 return I->second; 8630 } 8631 8632 APValue * 8633 ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E, 8634 bool MayCreate) { 8635 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static && 8636 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary"); 8637 if (MayCreate) { 8638 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E]; 8639 if (!MTVI) 8640 MTVI = new (*this) APValue; 8641 return MTVI; 8642 } 8643 8644 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E); 8645 } 8646 8647 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const { 8648 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 8649 if (!T.isOSDarwin()) 8650 return false; 8651 8652 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) && 8653 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9))) 8654 return false; 8655 8656 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 8657 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy); 8658 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity(); 8659 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy); 8660 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity(); 8661 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth(); 8662 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits); 8663 } 8664 8665 namespace { 8666 8667 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their 8668 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor. 8669 /// 8670 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST 8671 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context) 8672 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers. 8673 /// 8674 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes. 8675 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> { 8676 8677 public: 8678 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map. 8679 /// 8680 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap. 8681 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) { 8682 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap); 8683 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU); 8684 return Visitor.Parents; 8685 } 8686 8687 private: 8688 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase; 8689 8690 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) { 8691 } 8692 8693 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const { 8694 return true; 8695 } 8696 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const { 8697 return true; 8698 } 8699 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which 8700 // are not triggered during data recursion. 8701 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const { 8702 return false; 8703 } 8704 8705 template <typename T> 8706 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) { 8707 if (!Node) 8708 return true; 8709 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) { 8710 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only 8711 // when no memoization data is available for the type. 8712 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template 8713 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to 8714 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create 8715 // new matches. 8716 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash 8717 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions / 8718 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that 8719 // do not have pointer identity. 8720 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node]; 8721 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) { 8722 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back()); 8723 } else { 8724 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) { 8725 auto *Node = 8726 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>(); 8727 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node); 8728 NodeOrVector = Vector; 8729 delete Node; 8730 } 8731 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()); 8732 8733 auto *Vector = 8734 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>(); 8735 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data. 8736 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling 8737 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all 8738 // types. 8739 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() && 8740 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(), 8741 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end(); 8742 if (!Found) 8743 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back()); 8744 } 8745 } 8746 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node)); 8747 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node); 8748 ParentStack.pop_back(); 8749 return Result; 8750 } 8751 8752 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) { 8753 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl); 8754 } 8755 8756 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) { 8757 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt); 8758 } 8759 8760 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents; 8761 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack; 8762 8763 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>; 8764 }; 8765 8766 } // end namespace 8767 8768 ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode> 8769 ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) { 8770 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() && 8771 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be " 8772 "used in the parent map."); 8773 if (!AllParents) { 8774 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as 8775 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree. 8776 AllParents.reset( 8777 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl())); 8778 } 8779 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData()); 8780 if (I == AllParents->end()) { 8781 return None; 8782 } 8783 if (auto *N = I->second.dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) { 8784 return llvm::makeArrayRef(N, 1); 8785 } 8786 return *I->second.get<ParentVector *>(); 8787 } 8788 8789 bool 8790 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl, 8791 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) { 8792 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod. 8793 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() 8794 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) 8795 return false; 8796 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() != 8797 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier()) 8798 return false; 8799 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType())) 8800 return false; 8801 8802 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size()) 8803 return false; 8804 8805 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(), 8806 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(), 8807 EF = MethodDecl->param_end(); 8808 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) { 8809 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF); 8810 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM); 8811 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier()) 8812 return false; 8813 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType())) 8814 return false; 8815 } 8816 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic()); 8817 8818 } 8819 8820 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that 8821 // doesn't include ASTContext.h 8822 template 8823 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr< 8824 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType 8825 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr< 8826 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue( 8827 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value); 8828